[PATCH][GAS] aarch64: Add WFIT instruction for Armv8.7-a
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
CommitLineData
252b5132
RH
1\input texinfo
2@setfilename ld.info
b3adc24a 3@c Copyright (C) 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 4@syncodeindex ky cp
dff70155 5@c man begin INCLUDE
252b5132
RH
6@include configdoc.texi
7@c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
c428fa83 8@include bfdver.texi
dff70155 9@c man end
252b5132
RH
10
11@c @smallbook
12
ff5dcc92
SC
13@macro gcctabopt{body}
14@code{\body\}
15@end macro
16
0285c67d
NC
17@c man begin NAME
18@ifset man
19@c Configure for the generation of man pages
20@set UsesEnvVars
21@set GENERIC
0285c67d 22@set ARM
ac145307 23@set C6X
b8891f8d 24@set CSKY
49fa1e15 25@set H8300
0285c67d 26@set HPPA
0285c67d 27@set M68HC11
7fb9f789 28@set M68K
833794fc 29@set MIPS
3c3bdf30 30@set MMIX
2469cfa2 31@set MSP430
35c08157 32@set NDS32
78058a5e 33@set NIOSII
fa1477dc 34@set PDP11
2a60a7a8
AM
35@set POWERPC
36@set POWERPC64
49fa1e15 37@set Renesas
b4cbbe8f 38@set S/390
49fa1e15
AM
39@set SPU
40@set TICOFF
2ca22b03 41@set WIN32
e0001a05 42@set XTENSA
0285c67d
NC
43@end ifset
44@c man end
45
9160ea82
AM
46@ifnottex
47@dircategory Software development
48@direntry
252b5132 49* Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
9160ea82
AM
50@end direntry
51@end ifnottex
252b5132 52
0e9517a9 53@copying
e49e529d
JM
54This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57@end ifset
58version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 59
b3adc24a 60Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 61
cf055d54 62Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 63under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
cf055d54
NC
64or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 67section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0e9517a9 68@end copying
252b5132
RH
69@iftex
70@finalout
71@setchapternewpage odd
71ba23f6 72@settitle The GNU linker
252b5132 73@titlepage
71ba23f6 74@title The GNU linker
252b5132 75@sp 1
e49e529d
JM
76@subtitle @code{ld}
77@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79@end ifset
252b5132
RH
80@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81@author Steve Chamberlain
82@author Ian Lance Taylor
252b5132
RH
83@page
84
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
704c465c
NC
87\hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88\hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
71ba23f6 89\hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
252b5132
RH
90\hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91}
92\global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93@end tex
94
95@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
0285c67d 96@c man begin COPYRIGHT
b3adc24a 97Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 98
0285c67d 99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
0285c67d
NC
101or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 104section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0285c67d 105@c man end
252b5132 106
252b5132
RH
107@end titlepage
108@end iftex
4ecceb71 109@contents
252b5132
RH
110@c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
84ec0e6d 112@ifnottex
252b5132 113@node Top
71ba23f6 114@top LD
e49e529d
JM
115This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118@end ifset
119version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 120
cf055d54 121This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
793c5807
NC
122Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
cf055d54 124
252b5132
RH
125@menu
126* Overview:: Overview
127* Invocation:: Invocation
128* Scripts:: Linker Scripts
129@ifset GENERIC
130* Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
131@end ifset
132@ifclear GENERIC
133@ifset H8300
134* H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
135@end ifset
c2dcd04e
NC
136@ifset Renesas
137* Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
252b5132 138@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
139@ifset ARM
140* ARM:: ld and the ARM family
141@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
142@ifset M68HC11
143* M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
144@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
145@ifset HPPA
146* HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
147@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
148@ifset M68K
149* M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
150@end ifset
833794fc
MR
151@ifset MIPS
152* MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
153@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
154@ifset POWERPC
155* PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
156@end ifset
157@ifset POWERPC64
158* PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
159@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
160@ifset S/390
161* S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
162@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
163@ifset SPU
164* SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
165@end ifset
74459f0e
TW
166@ifset TICOFF
167* TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
168@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
169@ifset WIN32
170* Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
171@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
172@ifset XTENSA
173* Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
174@end ifset
252b5132
RH
175@end ifclear
176@ifclear SingleFormat
177* BFD:: BFD
178@end ifclear
179@c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
180
181* Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
182* MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
704c465c 183* GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
370b66a1 184* LD Index:: LD Index
252b5132 185@end menu
84ec0e6d 186@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
187
188@node Overview
189@chapter Overview
190
191@cindex @sc{gnu} linker
192@cindex what is this?
0285c67d 193
0879a67a 194@ifset man
0285c67d 195@c man begin SYNOPSIS
ff5dcc92 196ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
0285c67d
NC
197@c man end
198
199@c man begin SEEALSO
200ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
201the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
202@file{ld}.
203@c man end
204@end ifset
205
206@c man begin DESCRIPTION
207
ff5dcc92 208@command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
252b5132 209their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
ff5dcc92 210compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
252b5132 211
ff5dcc92 212@command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
252b5132
RH
213a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
214to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
215
0285c67d
NC
216@ifset man
217@c For the man only
ece2d90e 218This man page does not describe the command language; see the
71ba23f6
NC
219@command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
220language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
0285c67d
NC
221@end ifset
222
252b5132 223@ifclear SingleFormat
ff5dcc92
SC
224This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
225to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
252b5132
RH
226write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
227@code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
228available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
229@end ifclear
230
231Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
232linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
233execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
ff5dcc92 234@command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
252b5132
RH
235(or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
236
0285c67d
NC
237@c man end
238
252b5132
RH
239@node Invocation
240@chapter Invocation
241
0285c67d
NC
242@c man begin DESCRIPTION
243
ff5dcc92 244The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
252b5132
RH
245and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
246you have many choices to control its behavior.
247
0285c67d
NC
248@c man end
249
252b5132
RH
250@ifset UsesEnvVars
251@menu
a05a5b64 252* Options:: Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
253* Environment:: Environment Variables
254@end menu
255
256@node Options
a05a5b64 257@section Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
258@end ifset
259
260@cindex command line
261@cindex options
0285c67d
NC
262
263@c man begin OPTIONS
264
252b5132
RH
265The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
266practice few of them are used in any particular context.
267@cindex standard Unix system
ff5dcc92 268For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
252b5132
RH
269object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
270link a file @code{hello.o}:
271
272@smallexample
273ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
274@end smallexample
275
ff5dcc92 276This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
252b5132
RH
277result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
278the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
279directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
280
ff5dcc92 281Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
511ab9e9
ILT
282point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
283as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
284which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
285files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
286different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
252b5132
RH
287occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
288option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
289noted in the descriptions below.
290
291@cindex object files
511ab9e9
ILT
292Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
293together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
294options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
295an option and its argument.
252b5132
RH
296
297Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
298specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
299and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
300are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
301message @samp{No input files}.
302
36f63dca 303If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
252b5132
RH
304assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
305augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
306linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
307permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
308or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
53d25da6
AM
309@code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
310script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
311extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
312to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
313the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
252b5132
RH
314
315For options whose names are a single letter,
316option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
317whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
318option that requires them.
319
320For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
e4897a32 321precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
36f63dca 322@samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
e4897a32 323this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
ba1be17e 324only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
e4897a32
NC
325@samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
326name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
327output.
328
329Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
330option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
331immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
332@samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
333Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
334accepted.
252b5132 335
36f63dca 336Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
a05a5b64 337(e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
fa19fce0
NC
338prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
339compiler driver) like this:
4e53152f
NC
340
341@smallexample
2509a395 342 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
4e53152f
NC
343@end smallexample
344
345This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
2509a395
SL
346silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
347may also arise when passing options that require values through a
348driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
349a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
350and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
351the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
352
353@smallexample
354 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
355@end smallexample
4e53152f 356
a05a5b64 357Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
4e53152f
NC
358linker:
359
ff5dcc92 360@table @gcctabopt
38fc1cb1 361@include at-file.texi
dff70155 362
2509a395
SL
363@kindex -a @var{keyword}
364@item -a @var{keyword}
252b5132
RH
365This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
366argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
367@samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
368@samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
369to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
370
7ee314fa
AM
371@kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
372@item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
374@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
375specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
376will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
377finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
9d5777a3 378it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
7ee314fa 379This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
9d5777a3 380interface.
7ee314fa 381
252b5132
RH
382@ifclear SingleFormat
383@cindex binary input format
384@kindex -b @var{format}
385@kindex --format=@var{format}
386@cindex input format
387@cindex input format
388@item -b @var{input-format}
389@itemx --format=@var{input-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
390@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
391file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 392@samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
ff5dcc92 393that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
252b5132 394configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
ff5dcc92 395to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
252b5132
RH
396default input format the most usual format on each machine.
397@var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
398supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
399formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
400@xref{BFD}.
401
402You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
403binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
404linking object files of different formats), by including
405@samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
a1ab1d2a 406particular format.
252b5132
RH
407
408The default format is taken from the environment variable
409@code{GNUTARGET}.
410@ifset UsesEnvVars
411@xref{Environment}.
412@end ifset
413You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
0285c67d
NC
414@code{TARGET};
415@ifclear man
416see @ref{Format Commands}.
417@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
418@end ifclear
419
420@kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
421@kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
422@cindex compatibility, MRI
423@item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
424@itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
ff5dcc92 425For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
252b5132 426files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
0285c67d
NC
427@ifclear man
428@ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
429@end ifclear
430@ifset man
431the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
432@end ifset
433Introduce MRI script files with
252b5132 434the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
ff5dcc92
SC
435scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
436If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
252b5132
RH
437specified by any @samp{-L} options.
438
439@cindex common allocation
440@kindex -d
441@kindex -dc
442@kindex -dp
a1ab1d2a 443@item -d
252b5132
RH
444@itemx -dc
445@itemx -dp
446These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
447compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
448even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
449script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
450@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
451
7ee314fa
AM
452@kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
453@kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
454@item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
455@itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
456Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
457@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
458specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
459will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
460option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
9d5777a3 461The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
7ee314fa 462
abf874aa
CL
463@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
464@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
466fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
467section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
468error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
469several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
470section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
471sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
472
473@smallexample
474 MEMORY @{
475 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
476 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
477 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 @}
479 SECTIONS @{
480 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
481 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
482 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 @}
484
485 with input sections:
486 .data.1: size 8
487 .data.2: size 0x10
488 .data.3: size 4
489
490 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
491 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
492@end smallexample
493
494This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
495the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
496
497@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
498@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499This option enables warnings when
500@code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
501matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
502discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
503output region.
504
252b5132
RH
505@cindex entry point, from command line
506@kindex -e @var{entry}
507@kindex --entry=@var{entry}
a1ab1d2a 508@item -e @var{entry}
252b5132
RH
509@itemx --entry=@var{entry}
510Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
511program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
512named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
513and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
514base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
515@samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
516and other ways of specifying the entry point.
517
b58f81ae
DJ
518@kindex --exclude-libs
519@item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
520Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
e1c37eb5 521exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
b58f81ae
DJ
522@code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
523automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
524port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
525explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
526option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
527be treated as hidden.
528
e1c37eb5
DK
529@kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
530@item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
531Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
532should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
533into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
534may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
535used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
536the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
537match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
538command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
539of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
540regardless of this option.
541
252b5132
RH
542@cindex dynamic symbol table
543@kindex -E
544@kindex --export-dynamic
267e2722 545@kindex --no-export-dynamic
252b5132
RH
546@item -E
547@itemx --export-dynamic
267e2722
CD
548@itemx --no-export-dynamic
549When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
550option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
551all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
552set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
553
554If you do not use either of these options (or use the
555@option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
556dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
557referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
252b5132
RH
558
559If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
560back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
561dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
562linking the program itself.
563
55255dae 564You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
cb840a31 565be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
55255dae 566See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
cb840a31 567
8b747e1a
DK
568Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
569support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
570the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
571
37a141bf
FS
572@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
573@cindex export dynamic symbol
574@item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
575When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
576@var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
577shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
578bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
579no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
580@samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
581on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
582
583@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
584@cindex export dynamic symbol list
585@item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
586Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
587The format of the file is the same as the version node without
588scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
589
36f63dca 590@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
591@cindex big-endian objects
592@cindex endianness
593@kindex -EB
594@item -EB
595Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
596
597@cindex little-endian objects
598@kindex -EL
599@item -EL
600Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
36f63dca 601@end ifclear
252b5132 602
2509a395
SL
603@kindex -f @var{name}
604@kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
605@item -f @var{name}
606@itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
607When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
608to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
609table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
610symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
611
612If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
613run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
614the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
615first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
616@var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
617in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
618Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
619implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
a094d01f 620machine-specific performance.
252b5132
RH
621
622This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
623will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
624
2509a395
SL
625@kindex -F @var{name}
626@kindex --filter=@var{name}
252b5132 627@item -F @var{name}
2509a395 628@itemx --filter=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
629When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
630the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
631of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
632on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
633
634If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
635run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
636dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
637filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
638found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
639used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
640@var{name}.
641
ff5dcc92 642Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
252b5132 643toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
36f63dca
NC
644object files.
645@ifclear SingleFormat
646The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
ece2d90e 647@option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
252b5132 648@code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
36f63dca
NC
649environment variable.
650@end ifclear
651The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
652creating an ELF shared object.
252b5132 653
3dbf70a2 654@cindex finalization function
2509a395
SL
655@kindex -fini=@var{name}
656@item -fini=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
657When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
658executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
659address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
660the function to call.
661
252b5132
RH
662@kindex -g
663@item -g
664Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
665
2509a395
SL
666@kindex -G @var{value}
667@kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
252b5132 668@cindex object size
2509a395 669@item -G @var{value}
252b5132
RH
670@itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
671Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
672@var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
e8044f35 673MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
252b5132
RH
674sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
675
676@cindex runtime library name
2509a395 677@kindex -h @var{name}
252b5132 678@kindex -soname=@var{name}
2509a395 679@item -h @var{name}
252b5132
RH
680@itemx -soname=@var{name}
681When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
682the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
683which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
684linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
685field rather than the using the file name given to the linker.
686
687@kindex -i
688@cindex incremental link
689@item -i
690Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
691
3dbf70a2 692@cindex initialization function
2509a395
SL
693@kindex -init=@var{name}
694@item -init=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
695When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
696executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
697of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
698function to call.
699
252b5132 700@cindex archive files, from cmd line
2509a395 701@kindex -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf 702@kindex --library=@var{namespec}
2509a395 703@item -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf
RS
704@itemx --library=@var{namespec}
705Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
706list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
707If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
07d8eb55 708will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
bcb674cf 709will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
252b5132 710
ff5dcc92 711On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
bcb674cf
RS
712files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
713and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
714called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
715@file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
716indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
717to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
718@var{filename}.
252b5132
RH
719
720The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
721specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
722was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
723command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
724archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
725the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
726
ff5dcc92 727See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
252b5132
RH
728archives multiple times.
729
730You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
731
732@ifset GENERIC
733This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
ff5dcc92 734if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
252b5132
RH
735behaviour of the AIX linker.
736@end ifset
737
738@cindex search directory, from cmd line
2509a395 739@kindex -L @var{dir}
252b5132 740@kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
2509a395 741@item -L @var{searchdir}
252b5132 742@itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
ff5dcc92
SC
743Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
744for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
252b5132
RH
745option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
746in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
747on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
ff5dcc92 748@option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
7d24f02c
KH
749order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
750how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
751option is specified.
252b5132 752
3aa2d05a
NC
753If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
754prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
755@samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
9c8ebd6a 756
252b5132
RH
757@ifset UsesEnvVars
758The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
ff5dcc92 759@samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
252b5132
RH
760some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
761@end ifset
762
763The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
764@code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
765at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
766
767@cindex emulation
768@kindex -m @var{emulation}
2509a395 769@item -m @var{emulation}
252b5132
RH
770Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
771emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
772
773If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
774@code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
775
776Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
777configured.
778
779@cindex link map
780@kindex -M
781@kindex --print-map
782@item -M
783@itemx --print-map
784Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
785information about the link, including the following:
786
787@itemize @bullet
788@item
3b83e13a 789Where object files are mapped into memory.
252b5132
RH
790@item
791How common symbols are allocated.
792@item
793All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
794which caused the archive member to be brought in.
3b83e13a
NC
795@item
796The values assigned to symbols.
797
798Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
799involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
800have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
801linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
802of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
803the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
804linker script containing:
805
806@smallexample
807 foo = 1
808 foo = foo * 4
809 foo = foo + 8
810@end smallexample
811
812will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
813option is used:
814
815@smallexample
816 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
817 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
819@end smallexample
820
821See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
822scripts.
d2ef37eb 823
06ddcada
AM
824@item
825How GNU properties are merged.
d2ef37eb 826
06ddcada
AM
827When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
828.note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
829These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
d2ef37eb
L
830
831@smallexample
832Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
833@end smallexample
834
06ddcada 835This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
d2ef37eb
L
836merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
837is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
838
839@smallexample
06ddcada 840Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
d2ef37eb
L
841@end smallexample
842
06ddcada 843This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
d2ef37eb
L
844when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
845is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
252b5132
RH
846@end itemize
847
035801ce
FS
848@cindex link map discarded
849@kindex --print-map-discarded
850@kindex --no-print-map-discarded
851@item --print-map-discarded
852@itemx --no-print-map-discarded
853Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
854in the link map. Enabled by default.
855
252b5132
RH
856@kindex -n
857@cindex read-only text
858@cindex NMAGIC
859@kindex --nmagic
860@item -n
861@itemx --nmagic
90f5d9d9
JZ
862Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
863libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
864mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
252b5132
RH
865
866@kindex -N
867@kindex --omagic
868@cindex read/write from cmd line
869@cindex OMAGIC
a1ab1d2a 870@item -N
252b5132
RH
871@itemx --omagic
872Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
63fd3b82
NC
873not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
874libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
4d8907ac
DS
875mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
876is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
877specification published by Microsoft.
63fd3b82
NC
878
879@kindex --no-omagic
880@cindex OMAGIC
881@item --no-omagic
882This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
883sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
884be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
885shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
252b5132
RH
886
887@kindex -o @var{output}
888@kindex --output=@var{output}
889@cindex naming the output file
890@item -o @var{output}
891@itemx --output=@var{output}
ff5dcc92 892Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
252b5132
RH
893option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
894script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
895
f37b21b4
RM
896@kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
897@cindex dependency file
898@item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
899Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
900suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
901that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
902output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
903Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
904Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
905to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
906linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
907@samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
908installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
909distributed makefiles without careful editing.
910
252b5132
RH
911@kindex -O @var{level}
912@cindex generating optimized output
913@item -O @var{level}
ff5dcc92 914If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
252b5132 915the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
98c503ac
NC
916should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
917option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
918the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
919no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
920of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
252b5132 921
387dd777
DP
922@kindex -plugin @var{name}
923@item -plugin @var{name}
924Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
925the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
926automatically added by the complier, when using link time
927optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
928wish.
929
930Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
931from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
932@command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
933those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
41f37a6f 934copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
387dd777 935based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
6c19b93b 936just copy in the newest one.
387dd777 937
26278bb8
UD
938@kindex --push-state
939@cindex push state governing input file handling
940@item --push-state
941The @option{--push-state} allows to preserve the current state of the
942flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
943restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
944
945The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
946@option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
947@option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
948@option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
949@option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
950@option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
951
952One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
953used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
954listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
955something as follows:
956
957@smallexample
958-Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
959@end smallexample
960
961@kindex --pop-state
962@cindex pop state governing input file handling
67cecaba 963@item --pop-state
26278bb8
UD
964Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
965flags governing input file handling.
966
a712da20
NC
967@kindex -q
968@kindex --emit-relocs
969@cindex retain relocations in final executable
970@item -q
971@itemx --emit-relocs
ba1be17e 972Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
a712da20
NC
973Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
974order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
975in larger executables.
976
dbab7a7b
NC
977This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
978
4f471f39
RS
979@kindex --force-dynamic
980@cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
981@item --force-dynamic
982Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
983to VxWorks targets.
984
252b5132
RH
985@cindex partial link
986@cindex relocatable output
987@kindex -r
1049f94e 988@kindex --relocatable
252b5132 989@item -r
1049f94e 990@itemx --relocatable
252b5132 991Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 992turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
252b5132
RH
993linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
994magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
995@code{OMAGIC}.
ff5dcc92 996@c ; see @option{-N}.
252b5132
RH
997If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
998linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
999constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1000
62bf86b4
HPN
1001When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1002partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1003relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1004example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1005with input files in other formats at all.
1006
252b5132
RH
1007This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1008
1009@kindex -R @var{file}
1010@kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1011@cindex symbol-only input
1012@item -R @var{filename}
1013@itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1014Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1015relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1016to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1017programs. You may use this option more than once.
1018
ff5dcc92 1019For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 1020followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 1021the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
1022
1023@kindex -s
1024@kindex --strip-all
1025@cindex strip all symbols
a1ab1d2a 1026@item -s
252b5132
RH
1027@itemx --strip-all
1028Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1029
1030@kindex -S
1031@kindex --strip-debug
1032@cindex strip debugger symbols
a1ab1d2a 1033@item -S
252b5132
RH
1034@itemx --strip-debug
1035Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1036
a70f34c0
NC
1037@kindex --strip-discarded
1038@kindex --no-strip-discarded
1039@item --strip-discarded
1040@itemx --no-strip-discarded
1041Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1042Enabled by default.
1043
252b5132
RH
1044@kindex -t
1045@kindex --trace
1046@cindex input files, displaying
a1ab1d2a 1047@item -t
252b5132 1048@itemx --trace
4f4690cd
AM
1049Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1050@samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1051@samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1052and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1053a linker bug report.
252b5132
RH
1054
1055@kindex -T @var{script}
1056@kindex --script=@var{script}
1057@cindex script files
1058@item -T @var{scriptfile}
1059@itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1060Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
ff5dcc92 1061@command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
252b5132 1062@var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
114283d8
NC
1063output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1064the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1065specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1066options accumulate.
252b5132 1067
14be8564
L
1068@kindex -dT @var{script}
1069@kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1070@cindex script files
1071@item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1072@itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1073Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1074
1075This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1076processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1077command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1078@option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1079behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1080command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1081the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1082@samp{gcc}).
1083
252b5132
RH
1084@kindex -u @var{symbol}
1085@kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1086@cindex undefined symbol
1087@item -u @var{symbol}
1088@itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1089Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1090symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1091modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1092different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1093option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1094
0a618243
AB
1095If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1096into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1097undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1098instead.
1099
1100@kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1101@cindex symbols, require defined
1102@cindex defined symbol
1103@item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1104Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1105is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1106is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1107and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1108@code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1109can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1110
252b5132
RH
1111@kindex -Ur
1112@cindex constructors
a1ab1d2a 1113@item -Ur
252b5132
RH
1114For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1115@samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 1116turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
252b5132
RH
1117@emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1118It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1119with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1120be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1121@samp{-r} for the others.
1122
c005eb9e
AB
1123@kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1124@cindex orphan sections
1125@cindex sections, orphan
1126@item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1127Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1128specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1129
1130@var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1131
1132@table @code
1133@item place
1134Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1135the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
d2732b69 1136@samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
c005eb9e
AB
1137
1138@item discard
1139All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1140@samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1141
1142@item warn
1143The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1144issue a warning.
1145
1146@item error
1147The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1148@end table
1149
1150The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1151
577a0623
AM
1152@kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1153@item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1155@var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1156missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1157specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1158multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1159input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1160in a linker script.
a854a4a7 1161
252b5132
RH
1162@kindex -v
1163@kindex -V
1164@kindex --version
1165@cindex version
1166@item -v
1167@itemx --version
1168@itemx -V
ff5dcc92 1169Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
252b5132
RH
1170lists the supported emulations.
1171
1172@kindex -x
1173@kindex --discard-all
1174@cindex deleting local symbols
1175@item -x
1176@itemx --discard-all
1177Delete all local symbols.
1178
1179@kindex -X
1180@kindex --discard-locals
1181@cindex local symbols, deleting
a1ab1d2a 1182@item -X
252b5132 1183@itemx --discard-locals
3c68c38f
BW
1184Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1185system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1186or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
252b5132
RH
1187
1188@kindex -y @var{symbol}
1189@kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1190@cindex symbol tracing
1191@item -y @var{symbol}
1192@itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1193Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1194option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1195to prepend an underscore.
1196
1197This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1198don't know where the reference is coming from.
1199
1200@kindex -Y @var{path}
1201@item -Y @var{path}
1202Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1203for Solaris compatibility.
1204
1205@kindex -z @var{keyword}
1206@item -z @var{keyword}
cd6d6c15
NC
1207The recognized keywords are:
1208@table @samp
1209
e6e2dfbd
AM
1210@item bndplt
1211Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1212
1213@item call-nop=prefix-addr
1214@itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1215@itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1216@itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1217Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1218to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1219@option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1220@option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1221@option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1222@option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1223Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1224
233a0083
L
1225@item cet-report=none
1226@itemx cet-report=warning
1227@itemx cet-report=error
1228Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1229GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1230section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1231linker not report missing properties in input files.
1232@option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1233missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1234the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1235Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1236GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1237turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1238Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1239
cd6d6c15 1240@item combreloc
e6e2dfbd
AM
1241@itemx nocombreloc
1242Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1243dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
cd6d6c15 1244
b8871f35 1245@item common
e6e2dfbd
AM
1246@itemx nocommon
1247Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1248link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1249
1250@item common-page-size=@var{value}
1251Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1252layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1253using pages of this size.
b8871f35 1254
cd6d6c15 1255@item defs
97a232d7
NC
1256Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1257is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1258This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
cd6d6c15 1259
e6e2dfbd
AM
1260@item dynamic-undefined-weak
1261@itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1262Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1263if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1264by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1265@samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1266may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1267selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1268these options.
1269
6aa29e7b
JJ
1270@item execstack
1271Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1272
b039ef04
L
1273@item global
1274This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1275the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1276of subsequently loaded libraries.
1277
93ab9c0d
NC
1278@item globalaudit
1279This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1280This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1281setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1282tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
a05a5b64 1283the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
6c19b93b 1284all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
93ab9c0d 1285
e6e2dfbd
AM
1286@item ibtplt
1287Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1288Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1289
8df93cb5 1290@item ibt
e6e2dfbd
AM
1291Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1292to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1293Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1294
cd6d6c15
NC
1295@item initfirst
1296This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1297It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1298before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1299the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1300the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1301objects.
1302
1303@item interpose
e6e2dfbd
AM
1304Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1305so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1306libraries not so marked.
cd6d6c15 1307
5fa222e4
AM
1308@item lazy
1309When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1310dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1311the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1312Lazy binding is the default.
1313
cd6d6c15 1314@item loadfltr
e6e2dfbd 1315Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
cd6d6c15 1316
e6e2dfbd
AM
1317@item max-page-size=@var{value}
1318Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
cd6d6c15 1319
e6e2dfbd
AM
1320@item muldefs
1321Allow multiple definitions.
b8871f35 1322
cd6d6c15 1323@item nocopyreloc
daf220f0
AM
1324Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1325defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
cd6d6c15
NC
1326
1327@item nodefaultlib
e6e2dfbd
AM
1328Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1329should ignore any default library search paths.
cd6d6c15
NC
1330
1331@item nodelete
e6e2dfbd 1332Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
cd6d6c15
NC
1333
1334@item nodlopen
e6e2dfbd 1335Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
cd6d6c15
NC
1336
1337@item nodump
e6e2dfbd 1338Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
cd6d6c15 1339
6aa29e7b
JJ
1340@item noexecstack
1341Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1342
e6e2dfbd
AM
1343@item noextern-protected-data
1344Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1345library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1346used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1347generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1348module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1349i386 and x86-64.
8dfef1bd 1350
e6e2dfbd
AM
1351@item noreloc-overflow
1352Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1353relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1354overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
6aa29e7b 1355
cd6d6c15
NC
1356@item now
1357When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1358dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
e6e2dfbd
AM
1359when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1360function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1361called.
cd6d6c15
NC
1362
1363@item origin
e6e2dfbd 1364Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
cd6d6c15 1365
6aa29e7b 1366@item relro
e6e2dfbd 1367@itemx norelro
def5c83c
AM
1368Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1369specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1370relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1371than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
e6e2dfbd 1372Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
6aa29e7b 1373
47acac12
L
1374@item separate-code
1375@itemx noseparate-code
1376Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1377specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1378be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1379code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1380
496afd17
L
1381@item unique-symbol
1382@itemx nounique-symbol
1383Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1384".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1385is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1386
e6e2dfbd
AM
1387@item shstk
1388Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1389to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1390Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
24718e3b 1391
04c3a755 1392@item stack-size=@var{value}
e6e2dfbd 1393Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
04c3a755
NS
1394Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1395@code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1396
cae64165
RM
1397@item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1398@cindex visibility
1399@cindex ELF symbol visibility
1400Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1401@code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1402Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1403@samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1404start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1405compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1406recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1407programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1408between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1409
e6e2dfbd
AM
1410@item text
1411@itemx notext
1412@itemx textoff
a6dbf402
L
1413Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1414or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1415report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
48580982 1416
97a232d7
NC
1417@item undefs
1418Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1419either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1420This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1421
32930e4e
L
1422@item x86-64-v2
1423@item x86-64-v3
1424@itemx x86-64-v4
1425Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
1426@option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1427@option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1428@option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1429Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1430
cd6d6c15
NC
1431@end table
1432
ece2d90e 1433Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
252b5132
RH
1434
1435@kindex -(
1436@cindex groups of archives
1437@item -( @var{archives} -)
1438@itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1439The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1440either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1441
1442The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1443references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1444the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1445archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1446object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1447would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
5d3db3e2 1448they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
252b5132
RH
1449resolved.
1450
1451Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1452it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1453more archives.
1454
69da35b5
NC
1455@kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1456@kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1457@item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1458@itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1459Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
2ca22b03 1460recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
69da35b5
NC
1461and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1462the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1463behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1464so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1465restore the old behaviour.
2ca22b03 1466
4a43e768
AM
1467@kindex --as-needed
1468@kindex --no-as-needed
1469@item --as-needed
1470@itemx --no-as-needed
1471This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
ddbb8a31 1472on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
4a43e768
AM
1473the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1474on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
ddbb8a31 1475needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
ffa9430d
AM
1476emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1477non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1240be6b
AM
1478the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1479non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
ffa9430d
AM
1480Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1481the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1482needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1483from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
4a43e768 1484
e56f61be
L
1485@kindex --add-needed
1486@kindex --no-add-needed
1487@item --add-needed
1488@itemx --no-add-needed
ddbb8a31
NC
1489These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1490their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1491options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1492and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
e56f61be 1493
252b5132
RH
1494@kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1495@item -assert @var{keyword}
1496This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1497
1498@kindex -Bdynamic
1499@kindex -dy
1500@kindex -call_shared
1501@item -Bdynamic
1502@itemx -dy
1503@itemx -call_shared
1504Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1505for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1506default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1507for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1508multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
da8bce14 1509@option{-l} options which follow it.
252b5132 1510
a1ab1d2a
UD
1511@kindex -Bgroup
1512@item -Bgroup
1513Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1514section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1515object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
560e09e9
NC
1516@option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1517only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
a1ab1d2a 1518
252b5132
RH
1519@kindex -Bstatic
1520@kindex -dn
1521@kindex -non_shared
1522@kindex -static
a1ab1d2a 1523@item -Bstatic
252b5132
RH
1524@itemx -dn
1525@itemx -non_shared
1526@itemx -static
1527Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1528platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1529variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1530may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
560e09e9 1531library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
e9156f74
NC
1532option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1533option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1534shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1535references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
ece2d90e 1536libraries.
252b5132
RH
1537
1538@kindex -Bsymbolic
1539@item -Bsymbolic
1540When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1541definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1542for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1914e264
AM
1543within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1544platforms which support shared libraries.
252b5132 1545
40b36307
L
1546@kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1547@item -Bsymbolic-functions
1548When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
c0065db7 1549symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
40b36307 1550This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1914e264 1551libraries.
40b36307 1552
55255dae
L
1553@kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1554@item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1555Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1556typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1557global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1558within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1559to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1560in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1561which support shared libraries.
1562
1563The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1564scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1565
40b36307
L
1566@kindex --dynamic-list-data
1567@item --dynamic-list-data
1568Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1569
1570@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1571@item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1572Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1573is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1574
0b8a70d9
L
1575@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1576@item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1577Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1578
252b5132
RH
1579@kindex --check-sections
1580@kindex --no-check-sections
1581@item --check-sections
308b1ffd 1582@itemx --no-check-sections
252b5132 1583Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
7d816a17 1584been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
252b5132
RH
1585perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1586suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1587allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
a05a5b64 1588restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
02b0b1aa
NS
1589Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1590force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1591option.
252b5132 1592
ddbb8a31
NC
1593@kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1594@kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1595@item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1596@itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
9d5777a3 1597This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
ddbb8a31 1598by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
08efffb8 1599command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
ddbb8a31 1600output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
08efffb8 1601input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
ddbb8a31 1602specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
08efffb8
MM
1603follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1604behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
ddbb8a31
NC
1605
1606This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
08efffb8
MM
1607libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1608mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1609their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1610required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1611the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1612dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
ddbb8a31
NC
1613symbols.
1614
252b5132
RH
1615@cindex cross reference table
1616@kindex --cref
1617@item --cref
1618Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1619generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1620Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1621
1622The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1623easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1624sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1625symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
049c1c8e
NC
1626definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1627where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1628symbol are listed.
252b5132 1629
5dba6f05
NA
1630@cindex ctf variables
1631@kindex --ctf-variables
1632@kindex --no-ctf-variables
1633@item --ctf-variables
1634@item --no-ctf-variables
1635The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1636types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1637table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1638conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1639usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1640@option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1641The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1642
1643@cindex ctf type sharing
1644@kindex --ctf-share-types
1645@item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1646Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1647
1648@table @samp
1649@item share-unconflicted
1650Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1651where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1652translation unit. This is the default.
1653
1654@item share-duplicated
1655Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1656dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1657dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1658always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1659larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1660large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1661consumer at runtime.
1662@end table
1663
4818e05f
AM
1664@cindex common allocation
1665@kindex --no-define-common
1666@item --no-define-common
1667This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1668The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1669@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1670
1671The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1672the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1673of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1674forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1675Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1676from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1677This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1678and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1679duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1680paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1681
7bdf4127
AB
1682@cindex group allocation in linker script
1683@cindex section groups
1684@cindex COMDAT
1685@kindex --force-group-allocation
1686@item --force-group-allocation
1687This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1688normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1689default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1690change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1691command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1692effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1693
252b5132 1694@cindex symbols, from command line
2509a395
SL
1695@kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1696@item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
252b5132
RH
1697Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1698address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1699times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1700limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1701context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1702symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1703constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
66bc8739
AM
1704using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1705@emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1706equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
252b5132 1707
54874444
AB
1708The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1709in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1710symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1711placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1712the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1713consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1714@samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1715you are trying to achieve.
1716
252b5132 1717@cindex demangling, from command line
28c309a2 1718@kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132 1719@kindex --no-demangle
28c309a2 1720@item --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132
RH
1721@itemx --no-demangle
1722These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1723and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1724present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1725underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
a1ab1d2a
UD
1726mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1727different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1728to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
28c309a2
NC
1729demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1730is set. These options may be used to override the default.
252b5132
RH
1731
1732@cindex dynamic linker, from command line
506eee22 1733@kindex -I@var{file}
2509a395
SL
1734@kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1735@item -I@var{file}
1736@itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
252b5132
RH
1737Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1738generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1739linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1740doing.
1741
9b8b325a
RF
1742@kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1743@item --no-dynamic-linker
1744When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1745linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1746executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1747entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1748
a70f34c0
NC
1749@kindex --embedded-relocs
1750@item --embedded-relocs
1751This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
a094d01f 1752that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
a70f34c0
NC
1753is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1754targets.
1755
3f0a5f17
ME
1756@kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1757@item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1758Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1759in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1760
7ce691ae 1761@kindex --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd 1762@kindex --no-fatal-warnings
7ce691ae 1763@item --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd
NC
1764@itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1765Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1766with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
7ce691ae 1767
252b5132
RH
1768@kindex --force-exe-suffix
1769@item --force-exe-suffix
1770Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1771
1772If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1773@code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1774the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1775option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1776Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1777it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1778
1779@kindex --gc-sections
1780@kindex --no-gc-sections
1781@cindex garbage collection
c17d87de
NC
1782@item --gc-sections
1783@itemx --no-gc-sections
252b5132 1784Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
ac69cbc6 1785targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
b3549761 1786performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
0f088b2a
KT
1787@samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1788collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1789implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
252b5132 1790
d5465ba2
AM
1791@samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1792examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1793symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1794command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1795referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1796libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1797referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1798the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
b69e1ff3
CC
1799relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1800@samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
d5465ba2 1801
ac69cbc6 1802This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
9d5777a3 1803@samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
b69e1ff3
CC
1804specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1805@samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1806command in the linker script.
ac69cbc6 1807
c17d87de
NC
1808@kindex --print-gc-sections
1809@kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1810@cindex garbage collection
1811@item --print-gc-sections
1812@itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1813List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1814printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1815collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1816default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1817be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1818line.
1819
22185505 1820@kindex --gc-keep-exported
1821@cindex garbage collection
1822@item --gc-keep-exported
1823When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1824collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1825default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1826executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1827collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1828Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1829it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1830ELF format targets.
1831
30824704
RM
1832@kindex --print-output-format
1833@cindex output format
1834@item --print-output-format
1835Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1836other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1837in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1838
3604cb1f
TG
1839@kindex --print-memory-usage
1840@cindex memory usage
1841@item --print-memory-usage
1842Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1843the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1844quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1845headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1846parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1847
1848@smallexample
1849Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1850 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1851 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1852@end smallexample
1853
252b5132
RH
1854@cindex help
1855@cindex usage
1856@kindex --help
1857@item --help
1858Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1859
ea20a7da
CC
1860@kindex --target-help
1861@item --target-help
a094d01f 1862Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
ea20a7da 1863
2509a395
SL
1864@kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1865@item -Map=@var{mapfile}
252b5132 1866Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
72a3b182
NC
1867@option{-M} option, above. Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile}
1868causes the linker map to be written into a file inside the directory.
1869The name of the file is based upon the @var{output} filename with
1870@code{.map} appended.
252b5132
RH
1871
1872@cindex memory usage
1873@kindex --no-keep-memory
1874@item --no-keep-memory
ff5dcc92
SC
1875@command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
1876symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
252b5132 1877instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
ff5dcc92 1878necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
252b5132
RH
1879while linking a large executable.
1880
1881@kindex --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 1882@kindex -z defs
97a232d7 1883@kindex -z undefs
252b5132 1884@item --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 1885@itemx -z defs
560e09e9
NC
1886Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1887is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1888The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
1889behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
ece2d90e 1890libraries being linked in.
252b5132 1891
97a232d7
NC
1892The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
1893
aa713662
L
1894@kindex --allow-multiple-definition
1895@kindex -z muldefs
1896@item --allow-multiple-definition
1897@itemx -z muldefs
1898Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
1899report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
1900first definition will be used.
1901
b79e8c78 1902@kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 1903@kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
b79e8c78 1904@item --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 1905@itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
903249d7 1906Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
560e09e9
NC
1907This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
1908determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
1909shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
1910how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
1911
903249d7
NC
1912The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
1913referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
1914an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
1915a shared library.
1916
1917The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
1918libraries specified at link time are that:
1919
1920@itemize @bullet
1921@item
1922A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
1923that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
1924resolvable at load time.
1925@item
1926There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
1927symbols in shared libraries are normal.
1928
1929The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
1930select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
1931architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
1932appropriate memset function.
1933@end itemize
b79e8c78 1934
23ae20f5
NC
1935@kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
1936@item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
1937If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
1938@var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
1939only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
1940libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
93cf38c0
NC
1941``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
1942undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
1943will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
23ae20f5
NC
1944might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
1945error message will be displayed.
1946
1947The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
1948switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
1949
31941635
L
1950@kindex --no-undefined-version
1951@item --no-undefined-version
1952Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
1953it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
1954will be issued instead.
1955
3e3b46e5
PB
1956@kindex --default-symver
1957@item --default-symver
1958Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
fc0e6df6
PB
1959exported symbols.
1960
1961@kindex --default-imported-symver
1962@item --default-imported-symver
1963Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
1964imported symbols.
3e3b46e5 1965
252b5132
RH
1966@kindex --no-warn-mismatch
1967@item --no-warn-mismatch
ff5dcc92 1968Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
252b5132
RH
1969files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
1970been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
ff5dcc92 1971This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
252b5132
RH
1972errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
1973have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
1974inappropriate.
1975
fe7929ce
AM
1976@kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
1977@item --no-warn-search-mismatch
1978Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
1979library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
1980
252b5132
RH
1981@kindex --no-whole-archive
1982@item --no-whole-archive
ff5dcc92 1983Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
252b5132
RH
1984archive files.
1985
1986@cindex output file after errors
1987@kindex --noinhibit-exec
1988@item --noinhibit-exec
1989Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
1990Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
1991errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
1992when it issues any error whatsoever.
1993
0a9c1c8e
CD
1994@kindex -nostdlib
1995@item -nostdlib
1996Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
1997command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
1998(including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
1999
252b5132 2000@ifclear SingleFormat
2509a395
SL
2001@kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2002@item --oformat=@var{output-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
2003@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2004file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 2005@samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
ff5dcc92
SC
2006object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2007object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
2008should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2009usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2010name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2011list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2012command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2013this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2014@end ifclear
2015
76359541
TP
2016@kindex --out-implib
2017@item --out-implib @var{file}
2018Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2019the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2020library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2021may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2022behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2023step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2024the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2025
36af4a4e
JJ
2026@kindex -pie
2027@kindex --pic-executable
2028@item -pie
2029@itemx --pic-executable
2030@cindex position independent executables
2031Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2032ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2033libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
7e7d5768 2034address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
36af4a4e
JJ
2035normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2036defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2037
252b5132
RH
2038@kindex -qmagic
2039@item -qmagic
2040This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2041
2042@kindex -Qy
2043@item -Qy
2044This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2045
2046@kindex --relax
2047@cindex synthesizing linker
2048@cindex relaxing addressing modes
28d5f677 2049@cindex --no-relax
252b5132 2050@item --relax
28d5f677 2051@itemx --no-relax
a1ab1d2a 2052An option with machine dependent effects.
252b5132
RH
2053@ifset GENERIC
2054This option is only supported on a few targets.
2055@end ifset
2056@ifset H8300
ff5dcc92 2057@xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
252b5132 2058@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
2059@ifset XTENSA
2060@xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2061@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
2062@ifset M68HC11
2063@xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2064@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
2065@ifset NIOSII
2066@xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2067@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
2068@ifset POWERPC
2069@xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2070@end ifset
252b5132 2071
ccd9fae5 2072On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
28d5f677
NC
2073global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2074addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2075synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
11e7fd74 2076instructions, and combining constant values.
252b5132
RH
2077
2078On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2079debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2080@ifset GENERIC
28d5f677
NC
2081This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2082family of processors.
252b5132
RH
2083@end ifset
2084
ccd9fae5
NC
2085On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2086@option{--no-relax} will disable it.
28d5f677 2087
ccd9fae5
NC
2088On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2089and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2090
252b5132
RH
2091@cindex retaining specified symbols
2092@cindex stripping all but some symbols
2093@cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2509a395
SL
2094@kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2095@item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
252b5132
RH
2096Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2097discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2098symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2099@ifset GENERIC
2100(such as VxWorks)
2101@end ifset
2102where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2103run-time memory.
2104
2105@samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2106or symbols needed for relocations.
2107
2108You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2109line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2110
2111@ifset GENERIC
2509a395 2112@item -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2113@cindex runtime library search path
2509a395 2114@kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2115Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
ff5dcc92 2116linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
252b5132 2117arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
c1b00498
MR
2118them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2119
2120The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2121are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2122description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2123in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2124have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2125
2126If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2127contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2128is defined.
252b5132 2129
ff5dcc92 2130The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
d8506323 2131SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
ff5dcc92
SC
2132@option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2133runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2134options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2135gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
b45619c0 2136file systems.
252b5132 2137
ff5dcc92 2138For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 2139followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 2140the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
2141@end ifset
2142
2143@ifset GENERIC
2144@cindex link-time runtime library search path
2509a395
SL
2145@kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2146@item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
252b5132
RH
2147When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2148happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2149of the input files.
2150
2151When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2152non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2153shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
ff5dcc92 2154explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
252b5132 2155specifies the first set of directories to search. The
ff5dcc92 2156@option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
252b5132
RH
2157either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2158appearing multiple times.
2159
e680a6b6
NC
2160The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2161directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2162containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2163and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
216464-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2165
2166The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2167@var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2168supported.
2169
28c309a2
NC
2170This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2171that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2172is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2173runtime linker would do.
2174
252b5132 2175The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
ece2d90e 2176libraries:
d8e4137b 2177
252b5132
RH
2178@enumerate
2179@item
ff5dcc92 2180Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
252b5132 2181@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2182Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2183between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2184specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2185used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
ece2d90e
NC
2186at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2187by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2188the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
252b5132 2189@item
e2a83dd0
NC
2190On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2191@option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2192environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
252b5132 2193@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2194On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2195directories specified using @option{-L} options.
252b5132 2196@item
a1b8d843 2197For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
e2a83dd0 2198variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
252b5132 2199@item
ec4eb78a
L
2200For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2201@code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2202libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2203@code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2204@item
252b5132
RH
2205The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2206@item
d8e4137b
NC
2207For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2208exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2209to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2210defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2211configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2212@item
2213For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2214the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2215header file.
2216@item
2217Any directories specifed by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in the
2218linker script being used.
252b5132
RH
2219@end enumerate
2220
2221If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2222warning and continue with the link.
2223@end ifset
2224
2225@kindex -shared
2226@kindex -Bshareable
2227@item -shared
2228@itemx -Bshareable
2229@cindex shared libraries
2230Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2231and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
ff5dcc92 2232shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
252b5132
RH
2233undefined symbols in the link.
2234
252b5132 2235@kindex --sort-common
2509a395
SL
2236@item --sort-common
2237@itemx --sort-common=ascending
2238@itemx --sort-common=descending
de7dd2bd
NC
2239This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2240ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2241sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2242eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2243between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2244specified, then descending order is assumed.
252b5132 2245
2509a395
SL
2246@kindex --sort-section=name
2247@item --sort-section=name
bcaa7b3e
L
2248This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2249patterns in the linker script.
2250
2509a395
SL
2251@kindex --sort-section=alignment
2252@item --sort-section=alignment
bcaa7b3e
L
2253This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2254patterns in the linker script.
2255
a70f34c0
NC
2256@kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2257@item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2258This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2259.dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2260post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2261
252b5132 2262@kindex --split-by-file
2509a395 2263@item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
ff5dcc92 2264Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
a854a4a7
AM
2265each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2266size of 1 if not given.
252b5132
RH
2267
2268@kindex --split-by-reloc
2509a395 2269@item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
a854a4a7 2270Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
252b5132 2271output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
a854a4a7 2272This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
252b5132
RH
2273certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2274cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2275that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2276support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2277input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2278more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
a854a4a7 2279many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
252b5132
RH
2280
2281@kindex --stats
2282@item --stats
2283Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2284as execution time and memory usage.
2285
2509a395 2286@kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
e2243057
RS
2287@item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2288Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2289configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2290that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2291
a70f34c0
NC
2292@kindex --task-link
2293@item --task-link
2294This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2295file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2296
252b5132
RH
2297@kindex --traditional-format
2298@cindex traditional format
2299@item --traditional-format
ff5dcc92
SC
2300For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2301the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
252b5132
RH
2302use the traditional format instead.
2303
2304@cindex dbx
ff5dcc92 2305For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
252b5132
RH
2306symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2307full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2308@code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
ff5dcc92 2309trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
252b5132
RH
2310combine duplicate entries.
2311
2509a395
SL
2312@kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2313@item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
176355da
NC
2314Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2315address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2316times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2317line.
2318@var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2319for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2320@samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2321should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2322sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2323
2509a395
SL
2324@kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2325@kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2326@kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
252b5132 2327@cindex segment origins, cmd line
2509a395
SL
2328@item -Tbss=@var{org}
2329@itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2330@itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2331Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
a6e02871 2332@code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
252b5132 2333
2509a395
SL
2334@kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2335@item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
258795f5 2336@cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2b8c06a3
L
2337When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2338byte of the text segment.
258795f5 2339
9d5777a3
RM
2340@kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2341@item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2342@cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2343When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2344the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2345text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2346
0d705e9f
AM
2347@kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2348@item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2349@cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2350When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2351model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2352
560e09e9
NC
2353@kindex --unresolved-symbols
2354@item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2355Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2356values for @samp{method}:
2357
2358@table @samp
2359@item ignore-all
da8bce14 2360Do not report any unresolved symbols.
560e09e9
NC
2361
2362@item report-all
da8bce14 2363Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
560e09e9
NC
2364
2365@item ignore-in-object-files
2366Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2367ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2368
2369@item ignore-in-shared-libs
2370Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2371ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2372when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2373libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2374command line.
2375@end table
2376
2377The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2378by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2379
2380Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2381unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2382can change this to a warning.
2383
1715a13c
L
2384@kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2385@cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
252b5132 2386@item --dll-verbose
1715a13c 2387@itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
ff5dcc92 2388Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
252b5132 2389supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
1715a13c
L
2390the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2391argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
252b5132
RH
2392
2393@kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2394@cindex version script, symbol versions
2509a395 2395@item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
252b5132
RH
2396Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2397used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
36f63dca 2398about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
09e2aba4
DK
2399is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2400see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2401use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2402symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2403@xref{WIN32}.
252b5132 2404
7ce691ae 2405@kindex --warn-common
252b5132
RH
2406@cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2407@cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2408@item --warn-common
2409Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
11e7fd74 2410a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
252b5132
RH
2411but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2412you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
11e7fd74 2413Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
252b5132
RH
2414warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2415
2416There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2417
2418@table @samp
2419@item int i = 1;
2420A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2421file.
2422
2423@item extern int i;
2424An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2425There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2426variable somewhere.
2427
2428@item int i;
2429A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2430variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2431The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2432single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2433size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2434a definition of the same variable.
2435@end table
2436
2437The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2438Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2439just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2440encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2441a common symbol.
2442
2443@enumerate
2444@item
2445Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2446definition for the symbol.
2447@smallexample
2448@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2449 overridden by definition
2450@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2451@end smallexample
2452
2453@item
2454Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2455the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2456except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2457@smallexample
2458@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2459 overriding common
2460@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2461@end smallexample
2462
2463@item
2464Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2465@smallexample
2466@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2467 of `@var{symbol}'
2468@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2469@end smallexample
2470
2471@item
2472Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2473@smallexample
2474@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2475 overridden by larger common
2476@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2477@end smallexample
2478
2479@item
2480Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2481the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2482encountered in a different order.
2483@smallexample
2484@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2485 overriding smaller common
2486@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2487@end smallexample
2488@end enumerate
2489
2490@kindex --warn-constructors
2491@item --warn-constructors
2492Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2493object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2494detect the use of global constructors.
2495
2496@kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2497@item --warn-multiple-gp
2498Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2499This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2500Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2501section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2502of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2503base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2504base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2505bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2506large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2507values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2508option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2509
2510@kindex --warn-once
2511@cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2512@cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2513@item --warn-once
2514Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2515which refers to it.
2516
2517@kindex --warn-section-align
2518@cindex warnings, on section alignment
2519@cindex section alignment, warnings on
2520@item --warn-section-align
2521Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2522alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2523The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2524is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2525the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2526
a6dbf402
L
2527@kindex --warn-textrel
2528@item --warn-textrel
2529Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2530or shared object.
8fdd7217 2531
a0c402a5
L
2532@kindex --warn-alternate-em
2533@item --warn-alternate-em
2534Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2535
560e09e9
NC
2536@kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2537@item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2538If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2539@option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2540This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2541
2542@kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2543@item --error-unresolved-symbols
2544This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2545it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2546
252b5132
RH
2547@kindex --whole-archive
2548@cindex including an entire archive
2549@item --whole-archive
2550For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
ff5dcc92 2551@option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
252b5132
RH
2552in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2553files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2554library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2555library. This option may be used more than once.
2556
7ec229ce 2557Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
ff5dcc92
SC
2558about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2559Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
7ec229ce
DD
2560list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2561your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2562
2509a395
SL
2563@kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2564@item --wrap=@var{symbol}
252b5132
RH
2565Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2566@var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2567undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2568@var{symbol}.
2569
2570This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2571wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2572wishes to call the system function, it should call
2573@code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2574
2575Here is a trivial example:
2576
2577@smallexample
2578void *
cc2f008e 2579__wrap_malloc (size_t c)
252b5132 2580@{
cc2f008e 2581 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
252b5132
RH
2582 return __real_malloc (c);
2583@}
2584@end smallexample
2585
ff5dcc92 2586If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
252b5132
RH
2587all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2588instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2589call the real @code{malloc} function.
2590
2591You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
ff5dcc92 2592links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
252b5132
RH
2593you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2594file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2595call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2596
4ea904ed
SH
2597Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2598internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2599@code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2600@code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2601
2602@smallexample
2603int
2604f (void)
2605@{
2606 return 123;
2607@}
2608
2609int
2610g (void)
2611@{
2612 return f();
2613@}
2614@end smallexample
2615
6aa29e7b 2616@kindex --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b 2617@kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
6aa29e7b 2618@item --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b
NC
2619@itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2620Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2621(@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2622section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
6aa29e7b 2623
e41b3a13
JJ
2624@kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2625@item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2626Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2627generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2628if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2629
6c1439be
L
2630@kindex --enable-new-dtags
2631@kindex --disable-new-dtags
2632@item --enable-new-dtags
2633@itemx --disable-new-dtags
2634This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2635systems may not understand them. If you specify
b1b00fcc
MF
2636@option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2637and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
ff5dcc92 2638If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
6c1439be
L
2639created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2640those options are only available for ELF systems.
2641
2d643429 2642@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
e185dd51 2643@item --hash-size=@var{number}
2d643429
NC
2644Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2645close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2646time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2647increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2648value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2649
fdc90cb4
JJ
2650@kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2651@item --hash-style=@var{style}
2652Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2653@code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2654new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2655the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
c8455dc9
NC
2656hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2657but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
fdc90cb4 2658
0ce398f1
L
2659@kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2660@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2661@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2662@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2663@item --compress-debug-sections=none
2664@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2665@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2666@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
9af89fba
NC
2667On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2668compressed using zlib.
2669
2670@option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2671sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2672DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2673instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2674also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2675sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2676
2677The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2678@option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2679
2680Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2681sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2682for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2683uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2684
2685The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2686involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2687default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2688@option{--help} option.
0ce398f1 2689
35835446
JR
2690@kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2691@item --reduce-memory-overheads
2692This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
f2a8f148 2693linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
35835446 2694for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2d643429
NC
2695about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2696
4f9c04f7 2697Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2d643429 26981021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
a85785bc 2699run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2d643429
NC
2700has been used.
2701
2702The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2703enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
35835446 2704
c0065db7
RM
2705@kindex --build-id
2706@kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2707@item --build-id
2708@itemx --build-id=@var{style}
61e2488c 2709Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
6033bf41 2710or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
61e2488c
JT
2711unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2712@code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2713@sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2714@code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2715the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2716string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2717@code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2718is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
24382dca
RM
2719
2720The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2721that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2722unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2723to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2724file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2725string identifying the original linked file does not change.
c0065db7
RM
2726
2727Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2728@code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
252b5132
RH
2729@end table
2730
0285c67d
NC
2731@c man end
2732
36f63dca 2733@subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
252b5132 2734
0285c67d
NC
2735@c man begin OPTIONS
2736
ff5dcc92 2737The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
252b5132
RH
2738the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2739normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2740use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2741@code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2742like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2743symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2744object file).
2745
2746In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
a05a5b64 2747support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
252b5132
RH
2748PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2749values by either a space or an equals sign.
2750
ff5dcc92 2751@table @gcctabopt
252b5132
RH
2752
2753@kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2754@item --add-stdcall-alias
2755If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2756as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
bb10df36 2757[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2758
2759@kindex --base-file
2760@item --base-file @var{file}
2761Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2762addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2763@file{dlltool}.
bb10df36 2764[This is an i386 PE specific option]
252b5132
RH
2765
2766@kindex --dll
2767@item --dll
2768Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
ff5dcc92 2769@option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
252b5132 2770file.
bb10df36 2771[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2772
88183869
DK
2773@kindex --enable-long-section-names
2774@kindex --disable-long-section-names
2775@item --enable-long-section-names
2776@itemx --disable-long-section-names
56e6cf80 2777The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
88183869 2778the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
56e6cf80
NC
2779for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
2780fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
88183869
DK
2781to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
2782allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
2783disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
2784generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
2785as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
9d5777a3
RM
2786with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
2787GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3efd345c
DK
2788information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
2789option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
2790section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
2791when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
2792image and not stripping symbols.
88183869
DK
2793[This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
2794
252b5132
RH
2795@kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
2796@kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
2797@item --enable-stdcall-fixup
2798@itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
2799If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
36f63dca 2800do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
252b5132
RH
2801only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
2802resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
2803undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
2804@code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
2805to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
2806warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
2807import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
ff5dcc92 2808to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
252b5132 2809feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
ff5dcc92 2810@option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
252b5132 2811mismatches are considered to be errors.
bb10df36 2812[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2813
522f09cd
KT
2814@kindex --leading-underscore
2815@kindex --no-leading-underscore
2816@item --leading-underscore
2817@itemx --no-leading-underscore
2818For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
2819in target's description. By this option it is possible to
2820disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
2821
252b5132
RH
2822@cindex DLLs, creating
2823@kindex --export-all-symbols
2824@item --export-all-symbols
2825If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
2826be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
2827otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
2828explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
2829attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
2830option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
ece2d90e 2831@code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
b044cda1 2832@code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
ece2d90e
NC
2833exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
2834re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
2835such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
2836@code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
b044cda1
CW
2837@code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
2838Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
2839not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
ece2d90e 2840extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
b044cda1 2841(obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
ece2d90e 2842These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
b044cda1 2843@code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
ece2d90e 2844@code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
b044cda1 2845@code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
ece2d90e 2846@code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
bb10df36 2847[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2848
2849@kindex --exclude-symbols
1d0a3c9c 2850@item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
252b5132
RH
2851Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
2852exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
bb10df36 2853[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2854
2927aaca
NC
2855@kindex --exclude-all-symbols
2856@item --exclude-all-symbols
2857Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
2858[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2859
252b5132
RH
2860@kindex --file-alignment
2861@item --file-alignment
2862Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
2863file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
2864512.
bb10df36 2865[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2866
2867@cindex heap size
2868@kindex --heap
2869@item --heap @var{reserve}
2870@itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 2871Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 2872to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 2873committed.
bb10df36 2874[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2875
2876@cindex image base
2877@kindex --image-base
2878@item --image-base @var{value}
2879Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
2880the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
2881is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
2882your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
2883other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
2884for dlls.
bb10df36 2885[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2886
2887@kindex --kill-at
2888@item --kill-at
2889If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
2890symbols before they are exported.
bb10df36 2891[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2892
26d2d8a2
BF
2893@kindex --large-address-aware
2894@item --large-address-aware
b45619c0 2895If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
26d2d8a2 2896header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
b45619c0 2897greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
26d2d8a2
BF
2898or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
2899section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
2900[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2901
f69a2f97
NC
2902@kindex --disable-large-address-aware
2903@item --disable-large-address-aware
2904Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
2905This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
2906driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
2907addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
2908[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2909
252b5132
RH
2910@kindex --major-image-version
2911@item --major-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2912Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
bb10df36 2913[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2914
2915@kindex --major-os-version
2916@item --major-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2917Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 2918[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2919
2920@kindex --major-subsystem-version
2921@item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2922Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 2923[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2924
2925@kindex --minor-image-version
2926@item --minor-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2927Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 2928[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2929
2930@kindex --minor-os-version
2931@item --minor-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2932Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 2933[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2934
2935@kindex --minor-subsystem-version
2936@item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2937Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 2938[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2939
2940@cindex DEF files, creating
2941@cindex DLLs, creating
2942@kindex --output-def
2943@item --output-def @var{file}
2944The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
2945file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
2946(which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
2947library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
2948automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
bb10df36 2949[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2950
b044cda1 2951@cindex DLLs, creating
b044cda1
CW
2952@kindex --enable-auto-image-base
2953@item --enable-auto-image-base
d0e6d77b
CF
2954@itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
2955Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
2956@var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
2957By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
2958for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
2959execution are avoided.
bb10df36 2960[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
2961
2962@kindex --disable-auto-image-base
2963@item --disable-auto-image-base
2964Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
2965user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
2966default.
bb10df36 2967[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
2968
2969@cindex DLLs, linking to
2970@kindex --dll-search-prefix
2971@item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
489d0400 2972When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
ece2d90e 2973search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
560e09e9 2974@code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
b044cda1
CW
2975between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
2976uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
ece2d90e 2977@code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
bb10df36 2978[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
2979
2980@kindex --enable-auto-import
2981@item --enable-auto-import
ece2d90e 2982Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
317ff008
EB
2983DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
2984mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
2985[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2986
2987The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
2988feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
2989
2990Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
2991of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
2992PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
4d8907ac 2993
e2a83dd0
NC
2994Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
2995data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
2996placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
2997around a problem with consts that is described here:
2998http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
2999
4d8907ac
DS
3000Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3001see this message:
0d888aac 3002
ece2d90e 3003"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
0d888aac
CW
3004documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3005
ece2d90e
NC
3006This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3007ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
c0065db7
RM
3008allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3009fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3010constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
2f8d8971
NC
3011multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3012this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3013of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3014the warning, and exit.
3015
3016There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3017data type of the exported variable:
0d888aac 3018
2fa9fc65
NC
3019One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3020of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
560e09e9 3021this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
2fa9fc65 3022
c0065db7
RM
3023A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3024that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3025there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
0d888aac
CW
3026a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3027
3028@example
3029extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3030extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3031 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3032@end example
3033
3034or
3035
3036@example
3037extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3038extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3039 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3040@end example
3041
c0065db7 3042For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
2f8d8971 3043is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
0d888aac
CW
3044
3045@example
3046extern struct s extern_struct;
c0065db7 3047extern_struct.field -->
0d888aac
CW
3048 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3049@end example
3050
c406afaf
NC
3051or
3052
3053@example
3054extern long long extern_ll;
3055extern_ll -->
3056 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3057@end example
3058
2fa9fc65 3059A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
c0065db7 3060'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
11e7fd74 3061@code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
0d888aac 3062requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
c0065db7
RM
3063building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3064merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3065between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
0d888aac
CW
3066constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3067
3068Original:
3069@example
3070--foo.h
3071extern int arr[];
3072--foo.c
3073#include "foo.h"
3074void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3075 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3076@}
3077@end example
3078
3079Solution 1:
3080@example
3081--foo.h
3082extern int arr[];
3083--foo.c
3084#include "foo.h"
3085void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3086 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3087 volatile int *parr = arr;
3088 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3089@}
3090@end example
3091
3092Solution 2:
3093@example
3094--foo.h
3095/* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3096#if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3097 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3098#define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3099#else
3100#define FOO_IMPORT
3101#endif
3102extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3103--foo.c
3104#include "foo.h"
3105void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3106 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3107@}
3108@end example
3109
c0065db7 3110A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
0d888aac
CW
3111library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3112for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3113functions).
b044cda1
CW
3114
3115@kindex --disable-auto-import
3116@item --disable-auto-import
c0065db7 3117Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
b044cda1 3118@code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3119[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3120
2fa9fc65
NC
3121@kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3122@item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3123If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3124that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3125a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
c0065db7 3126environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
bb10df36 3127[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65
NC
3128
3129@kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3130@item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
317ff008 3131Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3132[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65 3133
b044cda1
CW
3134@kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3135@item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3136Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
bb10df36 3137[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3138
252b5132
RH
3139@kindex --section-alignment
3140@item --section-alignment
3141Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3142addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
bb10df36 3143[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3144
3145@cindex stack size
3146@kindex --stack
3147@item --stack @var{reserve}
3148@itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3149Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3150to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3151committed.
bb10df36 3152[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3153
3154@kindex --subsystem
3155@item --subsystem @var{which}
3156@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3157@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3158Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3159legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
33f362e1
NC
3160@code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3161the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3162@var{which}.
bb10df36 3163[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3164
2f563b51
DK
3165The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3166of the PE file header:
3167[These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3168
2d5c3743
NC
3169@kindex --high-entropy-va
3170@item --high-entropy-va
514b4e19 3171@itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
2d5c3743 3172Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
514b4e19
JD
3173(ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3174
dc9bd8c9
HD
3175This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3176@option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2d5c3743 3177
2f563b51
DK
3178@kindex --dynamicbase
3179@item --dynamicbase
514b4e19 3180@itemx --disable-dynamicbase
2f563b51
DK
3181The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3182randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
514b4e19
JD
3183Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3184can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
dc9bd8c9 3185This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2f563b51
DK
3186
3187@kindex --forceinteg
3188@item --forceinteg
514b4e19
JD
3189@itemx --disable-forceinteg
3190Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3191default.
2f563b51
DK
3192
3193@kindex --nxcompat
3194@item --nxcompat
514b4e19 3195@item --disable-nxcompat
2f563b51 3196The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
514b4e19
JD
3197This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3198targets. The option is enabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3199
3200@kindex --no-isolation
3201@item --no-isolation
514b4e19 3202@itemx --disable-no-isolation
2f563b51 3203Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
514b4e19 3204This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3205
3206@kindex --no-seh
3207@item --no-seh
514b4e19 3208@itemx --disable-no-seh
2f563b51 3209The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
514b4e19 3210this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3211
3212@kindex --no-bind
3213@item --no-bind
514b4e19
JD
3214@itemx --disable-no-bind
3215Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3216
3217@kindex --wdmdriver
3218@item --wdmdriver
514b4e19
JD
3219@itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3220The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3221by default.
9d5777a3 3222
2f563b51
DK
3223@kindex --tsaware
3224@item --tsaware
514b4e19
JD
3225@itemx --disable-tsaware
3226The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3227default.
2f563b51 3228
0cb112f7
CF
3229@kindex --insert-timestamp
3230@item --insert-timestamp
eeb14e5a
LZ
3231@itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3232Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3233as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3234other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
56e6cf80 3235will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
eeb14e5a
LZ
3236same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3237can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
56e6cf80 3238that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
eeb14e5a 3239identically.
dc9bd8c9
HD
3240
3241@kindex --enable-reloc-section
3242@item --enable-reloc-section
514b4e19 3243@itemx --disable-reloc-section
dc9bd8c9
HD
3244Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3245is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
514b4e19 3246This option is enabled by default.
252b5132
RH
3247@end table
3248
0285c67d
NC
3249@c man end
3250
ac145307
BS
3251@ifset C6X
3252@subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3253
3254@c man begin OPTIONS
3255
3256The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3257libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3258all executables use an index of 0.
3259
3260@table @gcctabopt
3261
3262@kindex --dsbt-size
3263@item --dsbt-size @var{size}
56e6cf80 3264This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
ac145307
BS
3265or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3266entries.
3267
3268@kindex --dsbt-index
3269@item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3270This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3271to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3272executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3273@code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3274
fbd9ad90
PB
3275@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3276The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3277exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3278
ac145307
BS
3279@end table
3280
3281@c man end
3282@end ifset
3283
b8891f8d
AJ
3284@ifset CSKY
3285@subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3286
3287@c man begin OPTIONS
3288
3289@table @gcctabopt
3290
3291@kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3292@item --branch-stub
3293This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3294sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3295usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3296can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3297the compiler or assembler.
3298
3299@kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3300@item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3301This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3302It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3303be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3304stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3305sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3306@samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3307linker should choose suitable defaults.
3308
3309@end table
3310
3311@c man end
3312@end ifset
3313
93fd0973
SC
3314@ifset M68HC11
3315@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3316
3317@c man begin OPTIONS
3318
3319The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3320memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3321
3322@table @gcctabopt
3323
3324@kindex --no-trampoline
3325@item --no-trampoline
3326This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3327is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3328instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3329
3330@kindex --bank-window
3331@item --bank-window @var{name}
3332This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3333the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3334The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3335paging and addresses within the memory window.
3336
3337@end table
3338
3339@c man end
3340@end ifset
3341
7fb9f789
NC
3342@ifset M68K
3343@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3344
3345@c man begin OPTIONS
3346
3347The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3348when linking for 68K targets.
3349
3350@table @gcctabopt
3351
3352@kindex --got
3353@item --got=@var{type}
3354This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3355@var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3356@samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3357Info entry for @file{ld}.
3358
3359@end table
3360
3361@c man end
3362@end ifset
3363
833794fc
MR
3364@ifset MIPS
3365@subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3366
3367@c man begin OPTIONS
3368
3369The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
8b10b0b3
MR
3370generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3371linking for MIPS targets.
833794fc
MR
3372
3373@table @gcctabopt
3374
3375@kindex --insn32
3376@item --insn32
3377@kindex --no-insn32
3378@itemx --no-insn32
3379These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3380generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3381or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
338232-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3383used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3384possible.
3385
8b10b0b3
MR
3386@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3387@item --ignore-branch-isa
3388@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3389@itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3390These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3391transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3392accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3393is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3394instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3395equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3396calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3397a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3398an error.
3399
3734320d
MF
3400@kindex --compact-branches
3401@item --compact-branches
3402@kindex --no-compact-branches
fa1477dc 3403@itemx --no-compact-branches
3734320d
MF
3404These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3405in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3406
833794fc
MR
3407@end table
3408
3409@c man end
3410@end ifset
3411
fa1477dc
SC
3412
3413@ifset PDP11
3414@subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3415
3416@c man begin OPTIONS
3417
3418For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3419produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3420for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3421targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3422defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3423here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3424
3425@table @gcctabopt
3426
3427@kindex -N
3428@item -N
3429@kindex --omagic
3430@itemx --omagic
3431
3432Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3433indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3434shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3435writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3436the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3437programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3438from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3439
3440@kindex -n
3441@item -n
3442@kindex --nmagic
3443@itemx --nmagic
3444
3445Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3446indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3447be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3448file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3449byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3450a @emph{pure executable} format.
3451
3452@kindex -z
3453@item -z
3454@kindex --imagic
3455@itemx --imagic
3456
3457Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3458indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3459data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3460instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3461larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3462to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3463shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3464option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3465and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3466this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3467executable} format.
3468
3469@kindex --no-omagic
3470@item --no-omagic
3471
3472Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3473
3474@end table
3475
3476@c man end
3477@end ifset
3478
252b5132
RH
3479@ifset UsesEnvVars
3480@node Environment
3481@section Environment Variables
3482
0285c67d
NC
3483@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3484
560e09e9 3485You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
36f63dca
NC
3486@ifclear SingleFormat
3487@code{GNUTARGET},
3488@end ifclear
3489@code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
252b5132 3490
36f63dca 3491@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
3492@kindex GNUTARGET
3493@cindex default input format
3494@code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3495use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3496of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
ff5dcc92 3497@code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
252b5132
RH
3498of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3499attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3500this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3501there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3502object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3503BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3504in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
36f63dca 3505@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
3506
3507@kindex LDEMULATION
3508@cindex default emulation
3509@cindex emulation, default
3510@code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3511@samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3512behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3513available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3514the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3515variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3516linker was configured.
252b5132
RH
3517
3518@kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3519@cindex demangling, default
3520Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3521@code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3522default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3523a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3524may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3525options.
3526
0285c67d
NC
3527@c man end
3528@end ifset
3529
252b5132
RH
3530@node Scripts
3531@chapter Linker Scripts
3532
3533@cindex scripts
3534@cindex linker scripts
3535@cindex command files
3536Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3537written in the linker command language.
3538
3539The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3540the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3541the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3542more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3543direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3544described below.
3545
3546The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3547yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
a05a5b64
TP
3548linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3549to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
252b5132
RH
3550such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3551
3552You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3553line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3554default linker script.
3555
3556You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3557to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3558Linker Scripts}.
3559
3560@menu
3561* Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3562* Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3563* Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3564* Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3565* Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3566* SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3567* MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3568* PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3569* VERSION:: VERSION Command
3570* Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3571* Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3572@end menu
3573
3574@node Basic Script Concepts
3575@section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3576@cindex linker script concepts
3577We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3578describe the linker script language.
3579
3580The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3581file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3582@dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3583The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3584purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3585among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3586section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3587in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3588
3589Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3590also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
56dd11f0 3591contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
252b5132
RH
3592the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3593A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3594area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3595loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3596which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3597of debugging information.
3598
3599Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3600first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3601the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3602@dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3603section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3604same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3605is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3606(this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3607based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3608RAM address would be the VMA.
3609
3610You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3611program with the @samp{-h} option.
3612
3613Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3614@dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3615has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3616information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3617will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3618static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3619referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3620
3621You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3622program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3623option.
3624
3625@node Script Format
3626@section Linker Script Format
3627@cindex linker script format
3628Linker scripts are text files.
3629
3630You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3631either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3632symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3633generally ignored.
3634
3635Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3636If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3637otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3638double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3639file name.
3640
3641You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3642@samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3643to whitespace.
3644
3645@node Simple Example
3646@section Simple Linker Script Example
3647@cindex linker script example
3648@cindex example of linker script
3649Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3650
3651The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3652@samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3653memory layout of the output file.
3654
3655The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3656describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3657code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3658@samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3659Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3660your input files.
3661
3662For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
36630x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3664linker script which will do that:
3665@smallexample
3666SECTIONS
3667@{
3668 . = 0x10000;
3669 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3670 . = 0x8000000;
3671 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3672 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3673@}
3674@end smallexample
3675
3676You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3677followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3678descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3679
252b5132
RH
3680The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3681sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3682counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3683other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3684current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3685incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3686@samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3687
3688The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3689required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3690after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3691which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3692wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3693means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3694
3695Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3696@samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3697@samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3698
3699The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3700the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3701at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3702output section, the value of the location counter will be
3703@samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3704effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
58434bc1 3705immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
252b5132
RH
3706
3707The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3708alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3709example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3710sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3711may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3712sections.
3713
3714That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3715
3716@node Simple Commands
3717@section Simple Linker Script Commands
3718@cindex linker script simple commands
3719In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3720
3721@menu
3722* Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3723* File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3724@ifclear SingleFormat
3725* Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3726@end ifclear
3727
4a93e180 3728* REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
252b5132
RH
3729* Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3730@end menu
3731
3732@node Entry Point
36f63dca 3733@subsection Setting the Entry Point
252b5132
RH
3734@kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3735@cindex start of execution
3736@cindex first instruction
3737@cindex entry point
3738The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3739point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3740entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3741@smallexample
3742ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3743@end smallexample
3744
3745There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3746entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3747stopping when one of them succeeds:
3748@itemize @bullet
a1ab1d2a 3749@item
252b5132 3750the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
a1ab1d2a 3751@item
252b5132 3752the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
a1ab1d2a 3753@item
a094d01f 3754the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
8a758655 3755targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3ab904c4 3756check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
a1ab1d2a 3757@item
252b5132 3758the address of the first byte of the @samp{.text} section, if present;
a1ab1d2a 3759@item
252b5132
RH
3760The address @code{0}.
3761@end itemize
3762
3763@node File Commands
36f63dca 3764@subsection Commands Dealing with Files
252b5132
RH
3765@cindex linker script file commands
3766Several linker script commands deal with files.
3767
3768@table @code
3769@item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3770@kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3771@cindex including a linker script
3772Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
3773be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
ff5dcc92 3774with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
252b5132
RH
377510 levels deep.
3776
4006703d
NS
3777You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
3778@code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
3779
252b5132
RH
3780@item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3781@itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3782@kindex INPUT(@var{files})
3783@cindex input files in linker scripts
3784@cindex input object files in linker scripts
3785@cindex linker script input object files
3786The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
3787in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
3788
3789For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
3790a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
3791then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
3792
3793In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
3794script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
3795
e3f2db7f
AO
3796In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
3797with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
3798located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
16171946
FS
3799for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
3800@code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
3801filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
3802@samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3803
3804If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
3805the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
3806found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
3807not found the linker will search through the archive library search
3808path.
252b5132 3809
ff5dcc92 3810If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
a05a5b64 3811name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
252b5132
RH
3812@samp{-l}.
3813
3814When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
3815files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
3816script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
3817
3818@item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3819@itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3820@kindex GROUP(@var{files})
3821@cindex grouping input files
3822The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
3823files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
3824new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
a05a5b64 3825in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
252b5132 3826
b717d30e
JJ
3827@item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3828@itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3829@kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
3830This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
3831commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
3832as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
3833with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
3834when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
3835@option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
3836and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
3837setting afterwards.
3838
252b5132
RH
3839@item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3840@kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
b45619c0 3841@cindex output file name in linker script
252b5132
RH
3842The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
3843@code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
3844@samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
a05a5b64 3845Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
252b5132
RH
3846precedence.
3847
3848You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
3849output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
3850
3851@item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3852@kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3853@cindex library search path in linker script
3854@cindex archive search path in linker script
3855@cindex search path in linker script
3856The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
ff5dcc92 3857@command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
252b5132 3858@code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
a05a5b64 3859on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
252b5132 3860are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
a05a5b64 3861the command-line option are searched first.
252b5132
RH
3862
3863@item STARTUP(@var{filename})
3864@kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
3865@cindex first input file
3866The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
3867that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
3868though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
3869when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
3870first file.
3871@end table
3872
3873@ifclear SingleFormat
3874@node Format Commands
36f63dca 3875@subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
252b5132
RH
3876A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
3877
3878@table @code
3879@item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3880@itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
3881@kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3882@cindex output file format in linker script
3883The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
3884output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
024531e2 3885exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 3886(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
252b5132
RH
3887line option takes precedence.
3888
3889You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
a05a5b64 3890formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
252b5132
RH
3891This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
3892desired endianness.
3893
3894If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
3895will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
3896output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
3897used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
3898
3899For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
3900command:
3901@smallexample
3902OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
3903@end smallexample
3904This says that the default format for the output file is
a05a5b64 3905@samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
252b5132
RH
3906option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
3907format.
3908
3909@item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3910@kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3911@cindex input file format in linker script
3912The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
3913files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
3914This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 3915(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
252b5132
RH
3916is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
3917command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
3918@end table
3919@end ifclear
3920
4a93e180
NC
3921@node REGION_ALIAS
3922@subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
3923@kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
3924@cindex region alias
3925@cindex region names
3926
3927Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
3928@ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
3929
3930@smallexample
3931REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
3932@end smallexample
3933
3934The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
3935memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
3936to memory regions. An example follows.
3937
3938Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
3939memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
3940that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
3941non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
3942access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
3943read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
3944sections:
3945
3946@itemize @bullet
3947@item
3948@code{.text} program code;
3949@item
3950@code{.rodata} read-only data;
3951@item
3952@code{.data} read-write initialized data;
3953@item
3954@code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
3955@end itemize
3956
3957The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
3958part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
3959output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
3960systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
3961@code{C}:
3962@multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
3963@item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
9d5777a3 3964@item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4a93e180
NC
3965@item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
3966@item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
3967@item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
3968@end multitable
3969The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
3970loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
3971the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
3972the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
3973
3974The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
3975includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
3976memory layout:
3977@smallexample
3978INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
3979
3980SECTIONS
3981 @{
3982 .text :
3983 @{
3984 *(.text)
3985 @} > REGION_TEXT
3986 .rodata :
3987 @{
3988 *(.rodata)
3989 rodata_end = .;
3990 @} > REGION_RODATA
3991 .data : AT (rodata_end)
3992 @{
3993 data_start = .;
3994 *(.data)
3995 @} > REGION_DATA
3996 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
3997 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
3998 .bss :
3999 @{
4000 *(.bss)
4001 @} > REGION_BSS
4002 @}
4003@end smallexample
4004
4005Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4006regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4007variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4008@table @code
4009@item A
4010Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4011@smallexample
4012MEMORY
4013 @{
4014 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4015 @}
4016
4017REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4018REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4019REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4020REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4021@end smallexample
4022@item B
4023Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4024into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4025@code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4026@smallexample
4027MEMORY
4028 @{
4029 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4030 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4031 @}
4032
4033REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4034REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4035REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4036REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4037@end smallexample
4038@item C
4039Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4040@code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4041initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4042system start into the @code{RAM}.
4043@smallexample
4044MEMORY
4045 @{
4046 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4047 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4048 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4049 @}
4050
4051REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4052REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4053REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4054REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4055@end smallexample
4056@end table
4057
4058It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4059@code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4060necessary:
4061@smallexample
4062#include <string.h>
4063
4064extern char data_start [];
4065extern char data_size [];
4066extern char data_load_start [];
4067
4068void copy_data(void)
4069@{
4070 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4071 @{
4072 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4073 @}
4074@}
4075@end smallexample
4076
252b5132 4077@node Miscellaneous Commands
36f63dca 4078@subsection Other Linker Script Commands
252b5132
RH
4079There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4080
4081@table @code
4082@item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4083@kindex ASSERT
4084@cindex assertion in linker script
4085Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4086with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4087
fd1c4238
NC
4088Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4089take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4090inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4091for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4092symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4093
4094@smallexample
4095 .stack :
4096 @{
4097 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4098 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4099 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4100 @}
4101@end smallexample
4102
4103will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4104PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4105can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4106
4107@smallexample
4108 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4109 .stack :
4110 @{
4111 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4112 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4113 @}
4114@end smallexample
4115
4116will work.
4117
252b5132
RH
4118@item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4119@kindex EXTERN
4120@cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4121Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4122symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4123modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4124each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4125command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4126
4127@item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4128@kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4129@cindex common allocation in linker script
4130This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
ff5dcc92 4131to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
252b5132
RH
4132output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4133
4818e05f
AM
4134@item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4135@kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4136@cindex common allocation in linker script
4137This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4138command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4139to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4140
7bdf4127
AB
4141@item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4142@kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4143@cindex group allocation in linker script
4144@cindex section groups
4145@cindex COMDAT
4146This command has the same effect as the
4147@samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4148@command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4149and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4150specified (@samp{-r}).
4151
53d25da6
AM
4152@item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4153@kindex INSERT
4154@cindex insert user script into default script
4155This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4156augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4157inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4158@var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4159default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4160sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4161linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4162insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4163linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4164default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4165of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4166to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4167is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4168
4169@smallexample
4170SECTIONS
4171@{
4172 OVERLAY :
4173 @{
4174 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4175 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4176 @}
4177@}
4178INSERT AFTER .text;
4179@end smallexample
4180
252b5132
RH
4181@item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4182@kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4183@cindex cross references
ff5dcc92 4184This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
252b5132
RH
4185references among certain output sections.
4186
4187In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4188using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4189will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4190errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4191a function defined in the other section.
4192
4193The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
ff5dcc92 4194@command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
252b5132
RH
4195an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4196@code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4197names.
4198
cdf96953
MF
4199@item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4200@kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4201@cindex cross references
4202This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4203references to one section from a list of other sections.
4204
4205The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4206output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4207a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4208there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4209must never call back.
4210
4211The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4212The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4213If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4214the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4215status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4216names, not input section names.
4217
252b5132
RH
4218@ifclear SingleFormat
4219@item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4220@kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4221@cindex machine architecture
4222@cindex architecture
4223Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4224of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4225architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4226the @samp{-f} option.
4227@end ifclear
01554a74
AM
4228
4229@item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4230@kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4231This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4232@var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4233in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4234@xref{Expression Section}.
252b5132
RH
4235@end table
4236
4237@node Assignments
4238@section Assigning Values to Symbols
4239@cindex assignment in scripts
4240@cindex symbol definition, scripts
4241@cindex variables, defining
4242You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
73ae6183 4243the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
252b5132
RH
4244
4245@menu
4246* Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
eb8476a6 4247* HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
252b5132 4248* PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
7af8e998 4249* PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
73ae6183 4250* Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
252b5132
RH
4251@end menu
4252
4253@node Simple Assignments
4254@subsection Simple Assignments
4255
4256You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4257
4258@table @code
4259@item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4260@itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4261@itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4262@itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4263@itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4264@itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4265@itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4266@itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4267@itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4268@end table
4269
4270The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4271@var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4272defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4273
4274The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
b5666f2f 4275may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
252b5132
RH
4276
4277The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4278
4279Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4280
4281You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4282statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4283section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4284
4285The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4286expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4287
4288Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4289assignments may be used:
4290
4291@smallexample
4292floating_point = 0;
4293SECTIONS
4294@{
4295 .text :
4296 @{
4297 *(.text)
4298 _etext = .;
4299 @}
156e34dd 4300 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
252b5132
RH
4301 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4302@}
4303@end smallexample
4304@noindent
4305In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4306zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4307the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4308defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4309upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4310
eb8476a6
MR
4311@node HIDDEN
4312@subsection HIDDEN
4313@cindex HIDDEN
4314For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4315exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4316
4317Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4318@code{HIDDEN}:
4319
4320@smallexample
4321HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4322SECTIONS
4323@{
4324 .text :
4325 @{
4326 *(.text)
4327 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4328 @}
4329 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4330 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4331@}
4332@end smallexample
4333@noindent
4334In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4335
252b5132
RH
4336@node PROVIDE
4337@subsection PROVIDE
4338@cindex PROVIDE
4339In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4340only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4341the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4342@samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4343@samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4344@code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4345@samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4346@code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4347
4348Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4349@smallexample
4350SECTIONS
4351@{
4352 .text :
4353 @{
4354 *(.text)
4355 _etext = .;
4356 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4357 @}
4358@}
4359@end smallexample
4360
4361In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
4362underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition error. If, on
4363the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
4364underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4365If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4366linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4367
b0daac83
NC
4368Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4369defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4370that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4371when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4372@samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4373
7af8e998
L
4374@node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4375@subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4376@cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4377Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4378hidden and won't be exported.
4379
73ae6183
NC
4380@node Source Code Reference
4381@subsection Source Code Reference
4382
4383Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4384intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4385a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4386symbol that does not have a value.
4387
4388Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4389transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4390stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4391prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4392mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4393of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4394variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4395linker script variable might be referred to as:
4396
4397@smallexample
4398 extern int foo;
4399@end smallexample
4400
4401But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4402
4403@smallexample
4404 _foo = 1000;
4405@end smallexample
4406
4407In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4408transformation has taken place.
4409
4410When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4411things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4412in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4413second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4414table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4415contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4416value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4417
4418@smallexample
4419 int foo = 1000;
4420@end smallexample
4421
10bf6894 4422creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
73ae6183
NC
4423holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4424number 1000 is initially stored.
4425
4426When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4427first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4428memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4429So:
4430
4431@smallexample
4432 foo = 1;
4433@end smallexample
4434
4435looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4436associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4437address. Whereas:
4438
4439@smallexample
4440 int * a = & foo;
4441@end smallexample
4442
10bf6894 4443looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
73ae6183
NC
4444and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4445the variable @samp{a}.
4446
4447Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4448the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4449an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4450
4451@smallexample
4452 foo = 1000;
4453@end smallexample
4454
4455creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4456the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4457address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4458linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4459access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4460
4461Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4462you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4463use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4464section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4465linker script contains these declarations:
4466
4467@smallexample
4468@group
4469 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
a5e406b5 4470 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
73ae6183
NC
4471 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4472@end group
4473@end smallexample
4474
4475Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4476
4477@smallexample
4478@group
4479 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
c0065db7 4480
73ae6183
NC
4481 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4482@end group
4483@end smallexample
4484
4485Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
5707d2ad
NC
4486Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4487arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4488
4489@smallexample
4490@group
4491 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4492
4493 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4494@end group
4495@end smallexample
4496
4497Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4498operators.
73ae6183 4499
252b5132 4500@node SECTIONS
36f63dca 4501@section SECTIONS Command
252b5132
RH
4502@kindex SECTIONS
4503The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4504into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4505
4506The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4507@smallexample
4508SECTIONS
4509@{
4510 @var{sections-command}
4511 @var{sections-command}
4512 @dots{}
4513@}
4514@end smallexample
4515
4516Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4517
4518@itemize @bullet
4519@item
4520an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4521@item
4522a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4523@item
4524an output section description
4525@item
4526an overlay description
4527@end itemize
4528
4529The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4530@code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4531those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4532understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4533the layout of the output file.
4534
4535Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4536below.
4537
4538If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4539linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4540section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4541input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4542example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4543in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4544
4545@menu
4546* Output Section Description:: Output section description
4547* Output Section Name:: Output section name
4548* Output Section Address:: Output section address
4549* Input Section:: Input section description
4550* Output Section Data:: Output section data
4551* Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4552* Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4553* Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4554* Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4555@end menu
4556
4557@node Output Section Description
36f63dca 4558@subsection Output Section Description
252b5132
RH
4559The full description of an output section looks like this:
4560@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 4561@group
7e7d5768 4562@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 4563 [AT(@var{lma})]
1eec346e 4564 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
4565 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4566 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
4567 @{
4568 @var{output-section-command}
4569 @var{output-section-command}
4570 @dots{}
abc9061b 4571 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
252b5132
RH
4572@end group
4573@end smallexample
4574
4575Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4576
4577The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4578name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
abc9061b
CC
4579The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4580the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
252b5132
RH
4581The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4582
4583Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4584
4585@itemize @bullet
4586@item
4587a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4588@item
4589an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4590@item
4591data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4592@item
4593a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4594@end itemize
4595
4596@node Output Section Name
36f63dca 4597@subsection Output Section Name
252b5132
RH
4598@cindex name, section
4599@cindex section name
4600The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4601meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4602support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4603must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4604example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4605output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4606names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4607quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4608characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4609commas must be quoted.
4610
4611The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4612Discarding}.
4613
4614@node Output Section Address
2a16d82a 4615@subsection Output Section Address
252b5132
RH
4616@cindex address, section
4617@cindex section address
4618The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
ea5cae92
NC
4619address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4620is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4621
4622If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4623section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4624to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4625alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4626contained within the output section.
4627
4628The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4629
4630@itemize @bullet
4631@item
4632If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4633is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4634in that region.
4635
4636@item
4637If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4638regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4639section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4640be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4641
4642@item
4643If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4644the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4645counter.
4646@end itemize
4647
4648@noindent
4649For example:
4650
252b5132
RH
4651@smallexample
4652.text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4653@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4654
252b5132
RH
4655@noindent
4656and
ea5cae92 4657
252b5132
RH
4658@smallexample
4659.text : @{ *(.text) @}
4660@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4661
252b5132
RH
4662@noindent
4663are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4664@samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4665counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
ea5cae92
NC
4666counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4667input sections.
252b5132
RH
4668
4669The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4670For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4671so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4672do something like this:
4673@smallexample
4674.text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4675@end smallexample
4676@noindent
4677This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4678aligned upward to the specified value.
4679
4680Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
6ce340f1
NC
4681location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4682sections are ignored).
252b5132
RH
4683
4684@node Input Section
36f63dca 4685@subsection Input Section Description
252b5132
RH
4686@cindex input sections
4687@cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4688The most common output section command is an input section description.
4689
4690The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4691You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4692in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4693map the input files into your memory layout.
4694
4695@menu
4696* Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4697* Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4698* Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4699* Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4700* Input Section Example:: Input section example
4701@end menu
4702
4703@node Input Section Basics
36f63dca 4704@subsubsection Input Section Basics
252b5132
RH
4705@cindex input section basics
4706An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4707by a list of section names in parentheses.
4708
4709The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4710describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4711
4712The most common input section description is to include all input
4713sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4714include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4715@smallexample
4716*(.text)
4717@end smallexample
4718@noindent
18625d54 4719Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
8f1732fc 4720@cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
18625d54
CM
4721of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4722match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4723example:
252b5132 4724@smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4725EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4726@end smallexample
4727@noindent
4728will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4729and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4730placed inside the section list, for example:
4731@smallexample
b4346c09 4732*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
252b5132 4733@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4734@noindent
4735The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4736two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4737more than one section, as described below.
252b5132
RH
4738
4739There are two ways to include more than one section:
4740@smallexample
4741*(.text .rdata)
4742*(.text) *(.rdata)
4743@end smallexample
4744@noindent
4745The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4746@samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
b6bf44ba
AM
4747first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4748they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
252b5132
RH
4749@samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4750@samp{.rdata} input sections.
4751
8f1732fc
AB
4752When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4753is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4754immediately following section, for example:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4755@smallexample
4756*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4757@end smallexample
4758@noindent
4759will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4760@file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4761from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4762exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
8f1732fc 4763could be modified to:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4764@smallexample
4765*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4766@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4767@noindent
4768Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4769before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4770all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4771@smallexample
4772EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4773@end smallexample
a5bf7d4f 4774
252b5132
RH
4775You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4776You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
4777needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
4778@smallexample
4779data.o(.data)
4780@end smallexample
4781
ae17ab41
CM
4782To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
4783of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
4784
4785Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
4786
4787@smallexample
4788@group
4789SECTIONS @{
4790 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
4791 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
4792@}
4793@end group
4794@end smallexample
4795
4796In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
4797input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
4798@code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
4799@samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
4800whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
4801
967928e9
AM
4802You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
4803matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
4804with no whitespace around the colon.
4805
4806@table @samp
4807@item archive:file
4808matches file within archive
4809@item archive:
4810matches the whole archive
4811@item :file
4812matches file but not one in an archive
4813@end table
4814
4815Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
4816wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
4817single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
4818@samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
4819within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
4820also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
4821other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
4822from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
4823command.
4824
252b5132
RH
4825If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
4826the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
4827commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
4828@smallexample
4829data.o
4830@end smallexample
4831
967928e9
AM
4832When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
4833and does not contain any wild card
252b5132
RH
4834characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
4835name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
4836did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
4837though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
4838@code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
4839the archive search path.
4840
4841@node Input Section Wildcards
36f63dca 4842@subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
252b5132
RH
4843@cindex input section wildcards
4844@cindex wildcard file name patterns
4845@cindex file name wildcard patterns
4846@cindex section name wildcard patterns
4847In an input section description, either the file name or the section
4848name or both may be wildcard patterns.
4849
4850The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
4851pattern for the file name.
4852
4853The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
4854
4855@table @samp
4856@item *
4857matches any number of characters
4858@item ?
4859matches any single character
4860@item [@var{chars}]
4861matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
4862character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
4863@samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
4864@item \
4865quotes the following character
4866@end table
4867
4868When a file name is matched with a wildcard, the wildcard characters
4869will not match a @samp{/} character (used to separate directory names on
4870Unix). A pattern consisting of a single @samp{*} character is an
4871exception; it will always match any file name, whether it contains a
4872@samp{/} or not. In a section name, the wildcard characters will match
4873a @samp{/} character.
4874
4875File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
4876specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
4877does not search directories to expand wildcards.
4878
4879If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
4880appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
4881will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
4882sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
4883@file{data.o} rule will not be used:
4884@smallexample
4885.data : @{ *(.data) @}
4886.data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
4887@end smallexample
4888
bcaa7b3e 4889@cindex SORT_BY_NAME
252b5132
RH
4890Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
4891in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
bcaa7b3e
L
4892this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
4893pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
4894@code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
252b5132
RH
4895into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
4896
bcaa7b3e 4897@cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
9a24a276
AM
4898@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4899@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
4900alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
4901alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
4902needed.
bcaa7b3e 4903
02ecc8e9 4904@cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
9a24a276
AM
4905@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4906@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
4907numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
4908section name before placing them in the output file. In
4909@code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
4910the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
4911@code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
02ecc8e9 4912
bcaa7b3e
L
4913@cindex SORT
4914@code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4915
4916When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
4917can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
4918
4919@enumerate
4920@item
4921@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 4922It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
bcaa7b3e
L
4923sections have the same name.
4924@item
4925@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 4926It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
bcaa7b3e
L
4927sections have the same alignment.
4928@item
c0065db7 4929@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
bcaa7b3e
L
4930treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
4931@item
4932@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
4933is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
4934@item
4935All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
4936@end enumerate
4937
a05a5b64 4938When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
bcaa7b3e 4939section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
a05a5b64 4940takes precedence over the command-line option.
bcaa7b3e
L
4941
4942If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
a05a5b64 4943command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
bcaa7b3e
L
4944treated as nested sorting command.
4945
4946@enumerate
4947@item
4948@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
4949@option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
4950@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
4951@item
4952@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
4953@option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
4954@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
4955@end enumerate
4956
4957If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
a05a5b64 4958command-line option will be ignored.
bcaa7b3e 4959
eda680f8 4960@cindex SORT_NONE
a05a5b64 4961@code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
eda680f8
L
4962section sorting option.
4963
252b5132
RH
4964If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
4965@samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
4966precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
4967
4968This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
4969files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
4970sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
4971The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
4972with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
4973linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
4974@smallexample
4975@group
4976SECTIONS @{
4977 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
4978 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
4979 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4980 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
4981@}
4982@end group
4983@end smallexample
4984
4985@node Input Section Common
36f63dca 4986@subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
252b5132
RH
4987@cindex common symbol placement
4988@cindex uninitialized data placement
4989A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
4990file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
4991linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
4992named @samp{COMMON}.
4993
4994You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
4995other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
4996particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
4997input files are placed in another section.
4998
4999In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5000@samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5001@smallexample
5002.bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5003@end smallexample
5004
5005@cindex scommon section
5006@cindex small common symbols
5007Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5008example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5009symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5010different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5011the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5012symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5013to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5014locations.
5015
5016@cindex [COMMON]
5017You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5018notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5019@samp{*(COMMON)}.
5020
5021@node Input Section Keep
36f63dca 5022@subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
252b5132
RH
5023@cindex KEEP
5024@cindex garbage collection
5025When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
a1ab1d2a 5026it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
252b5132
RH
5027This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5028with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
bcaa7b3e 5029@code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
252b5132
RH
5030
5031@node Input Section Example
36f63dca 5032@subsubsection Input Section Example
252b5132
RH
5033The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5034to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5035start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5036@samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5037follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5038@samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5039@samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5040All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5041files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5042
5043@smallexample
5044@group
5045SECTIONS @{
5046 outputa 0x10000 :
5047 @{
5048 all.o
5049 foo.o (.input1)
5050 @}
36f63dca
NC
5051@end group
5052@group
252b5132
RH
5053 outputb :
5054 @{
5055 foo.o (.input2)
5056 foo1.o (.input1)
5057 @}
36f63dca
NC
5058@end group
5059@group
252b5132
RH
5060 outputc :
5061 @{
5062 *(.input1)
5063 *(.input2)
5064 @}
5065@}
5066@end group
a1ab1d2a 5067@end smallexample
252b5132 5068
cbd0eecf
L
5069If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5070and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5071automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5072__stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5073indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5074respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5075C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5076
252b5132 5077@node Output Section Data
36f63dca 5078@subsection Output Section Data
252b5132
RH
5079@cindex data
5080@cindex section data
5081@cindex output section data
5082@kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5083@kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5084@kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5085@kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5086@kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5087You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5088@code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5089an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5090parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5091value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5092counter.
5093
5094The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5095store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5096bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5097stored.
5098
5099For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5100of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5101@smallexample
5102BYTE(1)
5103LONG(addr)
5104@end smallexample
5105
5106When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5107same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5108target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5109@code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5110@code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5111
5112If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5113which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5114When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5115true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5116endianness of the first input object file.
5117
36f63dca 5118Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
2b5fc1f5
NC
5119between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5120@smallexample
5121SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5122@end smallexample
5123whereas this will work:
5124@smallexample
5125SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5126@end smallexample
5127
252b5132
RH
5128@kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5129@cindex holes, filling
5130@cindex unspecified memory
5131You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5132current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5133otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5134gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
a139d329 5135with the value of the expression, repeated as
252b5132
RH
5136necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5137point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5138than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5139different parts of an output section.
5140
5141This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
563e308f 5142value @samp{0x90}:
252b5132 5143@smallexample
563e308f 5144FILL(0x90909090)
252b5132
RH
5145@end smallexample
5146
5147The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
9673c93c 5148section attribute, but it only affects the
252b5132
RH
5149part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5150entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
9673c93c 5151precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
a139d329 5152expression.
252b5132
RH
5153
5154@node Output Section Keywords
36f63dca 5155@subsection Output Section Keywords
252b5132
RH
5156There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5157commands.
5158
5159@table @code
5160@kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5161@cindex input filename symbols
5162@cindex filename symbols
5163@item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5164The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5165The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5166file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5167the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5168
5169This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5170normally used for any other object file format.
5171
5172@kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5173@cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5174@cindex constructors, arranging in link
5175@item CONSTRUCTORS
5176When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5177unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5178destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5179arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5180automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5181For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5182linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5183@code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5184ignored for other object file formats.
5185
5186The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
7e69709c
AM
5187constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5188Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5189the start and end of the global destructors. The
252b5132
RH
5190first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5191of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5192compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5193formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5194@code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5195the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5196destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5197@code{exit}.
5198
5199For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5200arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5201addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5202and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5203linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5204runtime code expects to see.
5205
5206@smallexample
5207 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5208 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5209 *(.ctors)
5210 LONG(0)
5211 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5212 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5213 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5214 *(.dtors)
5215 LONG(0)
5216 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5217@end smallexample
5218
5219If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5220which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5221are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5222are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
bcaa7b3e
L
5223command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5224@code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5225@samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
252b5132
RH
5226@samp{*(.dtors)}.
5227
5228Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5229and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5230need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5231scripts.
5232
5233@end table
5234
5235@node Output Section Discarding
36f63dca 5236@subsection Output Section Discarding
252b5132
RH
5237@cindex discarding sections
5238@cindex sections, discarding
5239@cindex removing sections
2edab91c
AM
5240The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5241This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5242may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
252b5132 5243@smallexample
49c13adb 5244.foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
252b5132
RH
5245@end smallexample
5246@noindent
5247will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
74541ad4
AM
5248@samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5249sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
2edab91c
AM
5250space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5251too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5252space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5253@samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5254@samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5255This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
74541ad4 5256
a0976ea4 5257The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
74541ad4
AM
5258on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5259symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
a0976ea4
AM
5260the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5261section is discarded.
252b5132
RH
5262
5263@cindex /DISCARD/
5264The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5265input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5266section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5267
a2e098c3
NC
5268Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5269discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5270members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5271Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5272
252b5132 5273@node Output Section Attributes
36f63dca 5274@subsection Output Section Attributes
252b5132
RH
5275@cindex output section attributes
5276We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5277like this:
0c71d759 5278
252b5132 5279@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 5280@group
7e7d5768 5281@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 5282 [AT(@var{lma})]
3bbec4bd 5283 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
5284 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5285 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
5286 @{
5287 @var{output-section-command}
5288 @var{output-section-command}
5289 @dots{}
562d3460 5290 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
252b5132
RH
5291@end group
5292@end smallexample
0c71d759 5293
252b5132
RH
5294We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5295@var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5296remaining section attributes.
5297
a1ab1d2a 5298@menu
252b5132
RH
5299* Output Section Type:: Output section type
5300* Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
bbf115d3 5301* Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
7e7d5768 5302* Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
0c71d759 5303* Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
252b5132
RH
5304* Output Section Region:: Output section region
5305* Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5306* Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5307@end menu
5308
5309@node Output Section Type
36f63dca 5310@subsubsection Output Section Type
252b5132
RH
5311Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5312parentheses. The following types are defined:
5313
5314@table @code
5315@item NOLOAD
5316The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5317loaded into memory when the program is run.
5318@item DSECT
5319@itemx COPY
5320@itemx INFO
5321@itemx OVERLAY
5322These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5323rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5324marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5325section when the program is run.
5326@end table
5327
5328@kindex NOLOAD
5329@cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5330@cindex loading, preventing
5331The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5332the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5333the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5334@samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
2e76e85a 5335need to be loaded when the program is run.
252b5132
RH
5336@smallexample
5337@group
5338SECTIONS @{
5339 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5340 @dots{}
5341@}
5342@end group
5343@end smallexample
5344
5345@node Output Section LMA
36f63dca 5346@subsubsection Output Section LMA
562d3460 5347@kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
252b5132
RH
5348@kindex AT(@var{lma})
5349@cindex load address
5350@cindex section load address
5351Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
ea5cae92
NC
5352@ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5353@pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5354specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5355address is optional.
6bdafbeb 5356
ea5cae92
NC
5357The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5358specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5359takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5360load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5361region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
dc0b6aa0
AM
5362
5363If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
ea5cae92
NC
5364section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5365load address:
5366
5367@itemize @bullet
5368@item
5369If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5370the LMA address as well.
5371
5372@item
5373If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5374
5375@item
5376Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5377with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5378section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5379VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5380the last section in the located region.
5381
5382@item
5383If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5384that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5385
5386@item
5387If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5388section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5389@end itemize
252b5132
RH
5390
5391@cindex ROM initialized data
5392@cindex initialized data in ROM
5393This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5394example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5395called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5396@samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5397even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5398uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5399defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5400counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5401
5402@smallexample
5403@group
5404SECTIONS
5405 @{
5406 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
a1ab1d2a 5407 .mdata 0x2000 :
252b5132
RH
5408 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5409 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5410 .bss 0x3000 :
5411 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5412@}
5413@end group
5414@end smallexample
5415
5416The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5417this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5418the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5419how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5420script.
5421
5422@smallexample
5423@group
5424extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5425char *src = &_etext;
5426char *dst = &_data;
5427
ea5cae92
NC
5428/* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5429while (dst < &_edata)
252b5132 5430 *dst++ = *src++;
252b5132 5431
ea5cae92 5432/* Zero bss. */
252b5132
RH
5433for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5434 *dst = 0;
5435@end group
5436@end smallexample
5437
bbf115d3
L
5438@node Forced Output Alignment
5439@subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5440@kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5441@cindex forcing output section alignment
5442@cindex output section alignment
1eec346e 5443You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
13075d04
SH
5444alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5445intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
bbf115d3 5446
7e7d5768
AM
5447@node Forced Input Alignment
5448@subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5449@kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5450@cindex forcing input section alignment
5451@cindex input section alignment
5452You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5453SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5454sections, whether larger or smaller.
5455
0c71d759
NC
5456@node Output Section Constraint
5457@subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5458@kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5459@kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5460@cindex constraints on output sections
5461You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5462of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5463read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5464@code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5465
252b5132 5466@node Output Section Region
36f63dca 5467@subsubsection Output Section Region
252b5132
RH
5468@kindex >@var{region}
5469@cindex section, assigning to memory region
5470@cindex memory regions and sections
5471You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5472using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5473
5474Here is a simple example:
5475@smallexample
5476@group
5477MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5478SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5479@end group
5480@end smallexample
5481
5482@node Output Section Phdr
36f63dca 5483@subsubsection Output Section Phdr
252b5132
RH
5484@kindex :@var{phdr}
5485@cindex section, assigning to program header
5486@cindex program headers and sections
5487You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5488using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5489one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5490assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5491@code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5492linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5493
5494Here is a simple example:
5495@smallexample
5496@group
5497PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5498SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5499@end group
5500@end smallexample
5501
5502@node Output Section Fill
36f63dca 5503@subsubsection Output Section Fill
252b5132
RH
5504@kindex =@var{fillexp}
5505@cindex section fill pattern
5506@cindex fill pattern, entire section
5507You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5508@samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5509(@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5510within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
a139d329
AM
5511alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5512necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
9673c93c 5513of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
a139d329
AM
5514an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5515fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
9673c93c 5516other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
a139d329
AM
5517pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5518expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
252b5132
RH
5519
5520You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
9673c93c 5521output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
252b5132
RH
5522
5523Here is a simple example:
5524@smallexample
5525@group
563e308f 5526SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
252b5132
RH
5527@end group
5528@end smallexample
5529
5530@node Overlay Description
36f63dca 5531@subsection Overlay Description
252b5132
RH
5532@kindex OVERLAY
5533@cindex overlays
5534An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5535are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5536the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5537copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5538required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5539can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5540than another.
5541
5542Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5543@code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5544output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5545command is as follows:
5546@smallexample
5547@group
5548OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5549 @{
5550 @var{secname1}
5551 @{
5552 @var{output-section-command}
5553 @var{output-section-command}
5554 @dots{}
5555 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5556 @var{secname2}
5557 @{
5558 @var{output-section-command}
5559 @var{output-section-command}
5560 @dots{}
5561 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5562 @dots{}
abc9061b 5563 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
252b5132
RH
5564@end group
5565@end smallexample
5566
5567Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5568section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5569section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
11e7fd74 5570those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
252b5132
RH
5571except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5572sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5573
abc9061b
CC
5574The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5575the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5576
252b5132
RH
5577The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5578addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5579memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5580whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5581and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5582and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5583
56dd11f0
NC
5584If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5585references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5586the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5587sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5588@xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
252b5132
RH
5589
5590For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
34711ca3 5591provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
252b5132
RH
5592defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5593@code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5594the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5595within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5596symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5597
5598At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5599the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5600
5601Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5602@code{SECTIONS} construct.
5603@smallexample
5604@group
5605 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5606 @{
5607 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5608 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5609 @}
5610@end group
5611@end smallexample
5612@noindent
5613This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5614address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5615@samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
34711ca3 5616following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
252b5132
RH
5617@code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5618@code{__load_stop_text1}.
5619
5620C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5621like the following.
5622
5623@smallexample
5624@group
5625 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5626 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5627 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5628@end group
5629@end smallexample
5630
5631Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5632everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5633example could have been written identically as follows.
5634
5635@smallexample
5636@group
5637 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5638 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5639 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
252b5132 5640 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5641 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5642 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
252b5132
RH
5643 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5644@end group
5645@end smallexample
5646
5647@node MEMORY
36f63dca 5648@section MEMORY Command
252b5132
RH
5649@kindex MEMORY
5650@cindex memory regions
5651@cindex regions of memory
5652@cindex allocating memory
5653@cindex discontinuous memory
5654The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5655memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5656
5657The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5658memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5659may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5660can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5661set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5662regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5663around to fit into the available regions.
5664
127fcdff
AB
5665A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5666however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5667specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5668@code{MEMORY} is:
252b5132
RH
5669@smallexample
5670@group
a1ab1d2a 5671MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5672 @{
5673 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5674 @dots{}
5675 @}
5676@end group
5677@end smallexample
5678
5679The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5680region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5681Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5682with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
4a93e180
NC
5683must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5684add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
9d5777a3 5685command.
252b5132
RH
5686
5687@cindex memory region attributes
5688The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5689whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5690not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5691@ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5692section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5693the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5694them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5695
5696The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5697@table @samp
5698@item R
5699Read-only section
5700@item W
5701Read/write section
5702@item X
5703Executable section
5704@item A
5705Allocatable section
5706@item I
5707Initialized section
5708@item L
5709Same as @samp{I}
5710@item !
c09e9a8c 5711Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
252b5132
RH
5712@end table
5713
81c688d5 5714If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
252b5132 5715@samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
81c688d5
NC
5716attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5717unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5718not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5719string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5720or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5721the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
252b5132
RH
5722
5723@kindex ORIGIN =
5724@kindex o =
5725@kindex org =
9cd6d51a
NC
5726The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5727the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5728cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5729abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5730@code{ORG}).
252b5132
RH
5731
5732@kindex LENGTH =
5733@kindex len =
5734@kindex l =
5735The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5736region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
9cd6d51a
NC
5737be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5738@code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
252b5132
RH
5739
5740In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5741available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5742and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5743linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5744is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5745or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5746explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5747region.
5748
5749@smallexample
5750@group
a1ab1d2a 5751MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5752 @{
5753 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5754 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5755 @}
5756@end group
5757@end smallexample
5758
5759Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5760specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5761@samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5762a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5763output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
5764was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5765the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
5766output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5767region, the linker will issue an error message.
5768
3ec57632 5769It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
c0065db7 5770expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
3ec57632
NC
5771@code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
5772
5773@smallexample
5774@group
c0065db7 5775 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
3ec57632
NC
5776@end group
5777@end smallexample
5778
252b5132
RH
5779@node PHDRS
5780@section PHDRS Command
5781@kindex PHDRS
5782@cindex program headers
5783@cindex ELF program headers
5784@cindex program segments
5785@cindex segments, ELF
5786The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
5787@dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
5788loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
5789program with the @samp{-p} option.
5790
5791When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
5792reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
5793program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
5794This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
5795interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
5796
5797The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
5798in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
5799precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
5800the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
5801not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
5802
5803The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
5804generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
5805ignore @code{PHDRS}.
5806
5807This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
5808@code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
5809
5810@smallexample
5811@group
5812PHDRS
5813@{
5814 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
5815 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
5816@}
5817@end group
5818@end smallexample
5819
5820The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
5821of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
5822header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5823with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5c1a3f0f
NS
5824must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
5825is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
252b5132
RH
5826
5827Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
5828system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
5829specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
5830sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
5831attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
5832Section Phdr}.
5833
5834It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
5835merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
5836repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
5837contain the section.
5838
5839If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
5840then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
5841not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
5842convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
5843placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
5844default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
5845segment at all.
5846
5847@kindex FILEHDR
5848@kindex PHDRS
5c1a3f0f 5849You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
252b5132
RH
5850the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
5851The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
5852file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5c1a3f0f 5853include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
4100cea3
AM
5854segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
5855these keywords.
252b5132
RH
5856
5857The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
5858value of the keyword.
5859
5860@table @asis
5861@item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
5862Indicates an unused program header.
5863
5864@item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
5865Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
5866the file.
5867
5868@item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
5869Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
5870
5871@item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
5872Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
5873found.
5874
5875@item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
5876Indicates a segment holding note information.
5877
5878@item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
5879A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
5880ABI.
5881
5882@item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
5883Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
5884
1a9ccd70
NC
5885@item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
5886Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
5887
252b5132
RH
5888@item @var{expression}
5889An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
5890be used for types not defined above.
5891@end table
5892
5893You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
5894in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
5895@code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
5896Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
5897output section attribute.
5898
5899The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
5900which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
5901explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
5902an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
5903header.
5904
5905Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
5906headers used on a native ELF system.
5907
5908@example
5909@group
5910PHDRS
5911@{
5912 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
5913 interp PT_INTERP ;
5914 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
5915 data PT_LOAD ;
5916 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
5917@}
5918
5919SECTIONS
5920@{
5921 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
5922 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
5923 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
5924 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
5925 @dots{}
5926 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
5927 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
5928 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
5929 @dots{}
5930@}
5931@end group
5932@end example
5933
5934@node VERSION
5935@section VERSION Command
5936@kindex VERSION @{script text@}
5937@cindex symbol versions
5938@cindex version script
5939@cindex versions of symbols
5940The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
5941only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
5942symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
5943a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
5944shared library.
5945
5946You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
5947you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
5948also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
5949
5950The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
5951@smallexample
5952VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
5953@end smallexample
5954
5955The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
5956Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
5957version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
5958version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
5959version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
5960scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
5961library.
5962
5963The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
5964examples.
5965
5966@smallexample
5967VERS_1.1 @{
5968 global:
5969 foo1;
5970 local:
a1ab1d2a
UD
5971 old*;
5972 original*;
5973 new*;
252b5132
RH
5974@};
5975
5976VERS_1.2 @{
5977 foo2;
5978@} VERS_1.1;
5979
5980VERS_2.0 @{
5981 bar1; bar2;
c0065db7 5982 extern "C++" @{
86043bbb 5983 ns::*;
bb1515f2
MF
5984 "f(int, double)";
5985 @};
252b5132
RH
5986@} VERS_1.2;
5987@end smallexample
5988
5989This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
5990version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
5991The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
5992a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
313e35ee
AM
5993of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
5994symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
5995is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
5996in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
86043bbb
MM
5997However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
5998name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
252b5132
RH
5999
6000Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6001depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6002to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6003
6004Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6005depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6006and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6007
6008When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6009specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6010unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
a981ed6f 6011unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
ae5a3597
AM
6012somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6013wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6014wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6015set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6016ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
252b5132
RH
6017
6018The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6019they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6020could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6021However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6022
0f6bf451 6023Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6b9b879a
JJ
6024in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6025symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6026won't.
6027
6028@smallexample
7c9c73be 6029@{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
9d201f2f 6030@end smallexample
6b9b879a 6031
252b5132
RH
6032When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6033symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6034requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6035shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6036loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6037linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6038application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6039way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6040all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6041search for each symbol reference.
6042
6043The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6044doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6045that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6046functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6047the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6048required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6049that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6050versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6051the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6052
6053There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6054first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6055source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6056script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6057maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6058@smallexample
6059__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6060@end smallexample
6061@noindent
6062in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6063be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6064The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
96a94295
L
6065@samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6066takes precedence over a version script.
252b5132
RH
6067
6068The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6069function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6070an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6071version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6072linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6073
6074To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6075source file. Here is an example:
6076
6077@smallexample
6078__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6079__asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6080__asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6081__asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6082@end smallexample
6083
6084In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6085unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6086example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6087@samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6088
6089When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6090some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6091this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6092@samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6093declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6094you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6095
6096If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6097within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
36f63dca 6098(i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
252b5132
RH
6099specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6100
cb840a31
L
6101You can also specify the language in the version script:
6102
6103@smallexample
6104VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6105@end smallexample
6106
c0065db7 6107The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
cb840a31
L
6108The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6109demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
bb1515f2
MF
6110patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6111@samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
cb840a31 6112
86043bbb
MM
6113Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6114described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6115or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6116the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6117whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6118cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6119might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6120should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6121expect when you upgrade.
6122
252b5132
RH
6123@node Expressions
6124@section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6125@cindex expressions
6126@cindex arithmetic
6127The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6128that of C expressions. All expressions are evaluated as integers. All
6129expressions are evaluated in the same size, which is 32 bits if both the
6130host and target are 32 bits, and is otherwise 64 bits.
6131
6132You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6133
6134The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6135expressions.
6136
6137@menu
6138* Constants:: Constants
0c71d759 6139* Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
252b5132 6140* Symbols:: Symbol Names
ecca9871 6141* Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
252b5132
RH
6142* Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6143* Operators:: Operators
6144* Evaluation:: Evaluation
6145* Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6146* Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6147@end menu
6148
6149@node Constants
6150@subsection Constants
6151@cindex integer notation
6152@cindex constants in linker scripts
6153All constants are integers.
6154
6155As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6156octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
8a308ae8 6157hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
11e7fd74 6158@samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
8a308ae8
NC
6159@samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6160value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
252b5132
RH
6161
6162@cindex scaled integers
6163@cindex K and M integer suffixes
6164@cindex M and K integer suffixes
6165@cindex suffixes for integers
6166@cindex integer suffixes
6167In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6168constant by
6169@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6170@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6171@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6172@code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6173@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6174@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6175@tex
6176${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6177@end tex
6178@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
8a308ae8
NC
6179respectively. For example, the following
6180all refer to the same quantity:
6181
252b5132 6182@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6183_fourk_1 = 4K;
6184_fourk_2 = 4096;
6185_fourk_3 = 0x1000;
8a308ae8 6186_fourk_4 = 10000o;
252b5132
RH
6187@end smallexample
6188
8a308ae8
NC
6189Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6190conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6191
0c71d759
NC
6192@node Symbolic Constants
6193@subsection Symbolic Constants
6194@cindex symbolic constants
6195@kindex CONSTANT
a094d01f 6196It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
0c71d759
NC
6197the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6198
6199@table @code
6200@item MAXPAGESIZE
6201@kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6202The target's maximum page size.
6203
6204@item COMMONPAGESIZE
6205@kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6206The target's default page size.
6207@end table
6208
6209So for example:
6210
6211@smallexample
9d5777a3 6212 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
0c71d759
NC
6213@end smallexample
6214
6215will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6216supported by the target.
6217
252b5132
RH
6218@node Symbols
6219@subsection Symbol Names
6220@cindex symbol names
6221@cindex names
6222@cindex quoted symbol names
6223@kindex "
6224Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6225and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6226Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6227specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6228keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6229@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6230"SECTION" = 9;
6231"with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
252b5132
RH
6232@end smallexample
6233
6234Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6235to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6236whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6237
ecca9871
L
6238@node Orphan Sections
6239@subsection Orphan Sections
6240@cindex orphan
6241Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6242are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6243script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
a87ded7b
AB
6244output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6245in which to place the orphaned input section.
6246
6247If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6248an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6249placed at the end of that output section.
6250
6251If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6252sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6253name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6254orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6255one new output section.
6256
6257If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6258then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
e299b355
AM
6259in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6260linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6261attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6262sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6263support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
ecca9871 6264
a05a5b64
TP
6265The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6266(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
c005eb9e
AB
6267output sections an orphan is placed in.
6268
252b5132
RH
6269@node Location Counter
6270@subsection The Location Counter
6271@kindex .
6272@cindex dot
6273@cindex location counter
6274@cindex current output location
6275The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6276current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6277location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6278within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6279anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6280
6281@cindex holes
6282Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6283moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
dc0b6aa0
AM
6284location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6285and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6286doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
252b5132
RH
6287
6288@smallexample
6289SECTIONS
6290@{
6291 output :
6292 @{
6293 file1(.text)
6294 . = . + 1000;
6295 file2(.text)
6296 . += 1000;
6297 file3(.text)
563e308f 6298 @} = 0x12345678;
252b5132
RH
6299@}
6300@end smallexample
6301@noindent
6302In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6303located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6304followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6305@file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
563e308f 6306@samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
252b5132
RH
6307specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6308
5c6bbab8
NC
6309@cindex dot inside sections
6310Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6311current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
69da35b5 6312statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
5c6bbab8
NC
6313absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6314however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6315not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6316
6317@smallexample
6318SECTIONS
6319@{
6320 . = 0x100
6321 .text: @{
6322 *(.text)
6323 . = 0x200
6324 @}
6325 . = 0x500
6326 .data: @{
6327 *(.data)
6328 . += 0x600
6329 @}
6330@}
6331@end smallexample
6332
6333The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6334and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6335the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6336much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6337move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6338and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6339the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6340the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6341
b5666f2f
AM
6342@cindex dot outside sections
6343Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6344output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6345needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6346
6347@smallexample
6348SECTIONS
6349@{
6350 start_of_text = . ;
6351 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6352 end_of_text = . ;
6353
6354 start_of_data = . ;
6355 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6356 end_of_data = . ;
6357@}
6358@end smallexample
6359
6360If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6361not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6362between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6363should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6364blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6365the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6366sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6367statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6368special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6369place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6370as follows:
6371
6372@smallexample
6373SECTIONS
6374@{
6375 start_of_text = . ;
6376 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6377 end_of_text = . ;
6378
6379 start_of_data = . ;
6380 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6381 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6382 end_of_data = . ;
6383@}
6384@end smallexample
6385
6386This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6387@code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6388placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6389assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6390a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6391section. So you could write:
6392
6393@smallexample
6394SECTIONS
6395@{
6396 start_of_text = . ;
6397 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6398 end_of_text = . ;
6399
6400 . = . ;
6401 start_of_data = . ;
6402 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6403 end_of_data = . ;
6404@}
6405@end smallexample
6406
6407Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6408@code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6409
252b5132
RH
6410@need 2000
6411@node Operators
6412@subsection Operators
6413@cindex operators for arithmetic
6414@cindex arithmetic operators
6415@cindex precedence in expressions
6416The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6417the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6418@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6419@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6420@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6421@smallexample
6422precedence associativity Operators Notes
6423(highest)
64241 left ! - ~ (1)
64252 left * / %
64263 left + -
64274 left >> <<
64285 left == != > < <= >=
64296 left &
64307 left |
64318 left &&
64329 left ||
643310 right ? :
643411 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6435(lowest)
6436@end smallexample
6437Notes:
a1ab1d2a 6438(1) Prefix operators
252b5132
RH
6439(2) @xref{Assignments}.
6440@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6441@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6442@tex
6443\vskip \baselineskip
6444%"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6445\hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6446\hrule
6447\halign
6448{\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6449height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6450&Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6451height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6452\noalign{\hrule}
6453height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6454&highest&&&&&\cr
6455% '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
a1ab1d2a 6456&1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6457&2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6458&3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6459&4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6460&5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6461&6&&left&&\&&\cr
6462&7&&left&&|&\cr
6463&8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6464&9&&left&&||&\cr
6465&10&&right&&? :&\cr
6466&11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6467&lowest&&&&&\cr
6468height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6469\hrule}
6470@end tex
6471@iftex
6472{
6473@obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6474@dag@quad Prefix operators.
6475@ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6476}
6477@end iftex
6478@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6479
6480@node Evaluation
6481@subsection Evaluation
6482@cindex lazy evaluation
6483@cindex expression evaluation order
6484The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6485an expression when absolutely necessary.
6486
6487The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6488address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6489regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6490as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6491
6492However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6493until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6494other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6495for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6496
6497The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6498assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6499allocation.
6500
6501Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6502@samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6503
6504If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6505available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6506following
6507@smallexample
6508@group
6509SECTIONS
6510 @{
a1ab1d2a 6511 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
252b5132
RH
6512 @{ *(.text) @}
6513 @}
6514@end group
6515@end smallexample
6516@noindent
6517will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6518address}.
6519
6520@node Expression Section
6521@subsection The Section of an Expression
6522@cindex expression sections
6523@cindex absolute expressions
6524@cindex relative expressions
6525@cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6526@cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6527@cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
7542af2a
AM
6528Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6529relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6530using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6531value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6532symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6533operations.
6534
abf4be64
AM
6535Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6536section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6537address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6538@code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6539functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
01554a74
AM
6540One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6541(@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
5c3049d2
AM
6542differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6543versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6544section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6545Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
01554a74
AM
6546absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6547given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6548everywhere.
5c3049d2
AM
6549
6550In the following simple example,
252b5132 6551
7542af2a
AM
6552@smallexample
6553@group
6554SECTIONS
6555 @{
6556 . = 0x100;
6557 __executable_start = 0x100;
6558 .data :
6559 @{
6560 . = 0x10;
6561 __data_start = 0x10;
6562 *(.data)
6563 @}
6564 @dots{}
6565 @}
6566@end group
6567@end smallexample
252b5132 6568
7542af2a
AM
6569both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6570address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6571@code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6572section in the second two assignments.
252b5132 6573
5c3049d2
AM
6574For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6575addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
7542af2a
AM
6576
6577@itemize @bullet
6578@item
c05f749e
AM
6579Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6580operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6581absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6582@item
7542af2a
AM
6583Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6584relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6585and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6586@item
c05f749e
AM
6587Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6588in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6589address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6590before applying the operator.
7542af2a
AM
6591@end itemize
6592
6593The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6594
6595@itemize @bullet
6596@item
6597An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6598@item
6599The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6600@item
9bc8bb33 6601The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
11e7fd74 6602relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
94b41882
AM
6603(after above conversions) is also a number when
6604@code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6605but an absolute address otherwise.
9bc8bb33
AM
6606@item
6607The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6608relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6609section as the relative operand(s).
7542af2a
AM
6610@item
6611The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6612conversions) is an absolute address.
6613@end itemize
252b5132
RH
6614
6615You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6616to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6617create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6618section @samp{.data}:
6619@smallexample
6620SECTIONS
6621 @{
6622 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6623 @}
6624@end smallexample
6625@noindent
6626If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6627@samp{.data} section.
6628
7542af2a
AM
6629Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6630particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6631
252b5132
RH
6632@node Builtin Functions
6633@subsection Builtin Functions
6634@cindex functions in expressions
6635The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6636use in linker script expressions.
6637
6638@table @code
6639@item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6640@kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6641@cindex expression, absolute
6642Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6643of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6644value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6645normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6646
6647@item ADDR(@var{section})
6648@kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6649@cindex section address in expression
7542af2a 6650Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
252b5132 6651script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7542af2a
AM
6652the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6653@code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6654@code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6655the other two will be absolute:
252b5132
RH
6656@smallexample
6657@group
6658SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6659 .output1 :
a1ab1d2a 6660 @{
252b5132
RH
6661 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6662 @dots{}
6663 @}
6664 .output :
6665 @{
6666 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6667 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6668 @}
6669@dots{} @}
6670@end group
6671@end smallexample
6672
876f4090
NS
6673@item ALIGN(@var{align})
6674@itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6675@kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6676@kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
252b5132
RH
6677@cindex round up location counter
6678@cindex align location counter
876f4090
NS
6679@cindex round up expression
6680@cindex align expression
6681Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6682to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6683doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6684arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6685expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
e0a3af22 6686equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
876f4090
NS
6687
6688Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6689next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6690variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6691input sections:
252b5132
RH
6692@smallexample
6693@group
6694SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6695 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6696 *(.data)
6697 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6698 @}
6699@dots{} @}
6700@end group
6701@end smallexample
6702@noindent
6703The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6704a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6705a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6706of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6707
6708The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6709
362c1d1a
NS
6710@item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6711@kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6712@cindex section alignment
6713Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6714been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6715evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6716the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6717value in that section.
6718@smallexample
6719@group
6720SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6721 .output @{
6722 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6723 @dots{}
6724 @}
6725@dots{} @}
6726@end group
6727@end smallexample
6728
252b5132
RH
6729@item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6730@kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6731This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6732scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6733section.
6734
2d20f7bf
JJ
6735@item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6736@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6737This is equivalent to either
6738@smallexample
6739(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6740@end smallexample
6741or
6742@smallexample
fe6052e1
AM
6743(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6744 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
2d20f7bf
JJ
6745@end smallexample
6746@noindent
6747depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6748for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6749@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6750If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6751memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6752bytes in the on-disk file.
6753
6754This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6755any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6756@var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
def5c83c
AM
6757be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6758running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6759that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6760page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
2d20f7bf
JJ
6761
6762@noindent
6763Example:
6764@smallexample
6765 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
6766@end smallexample
6767
6768@item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6769@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6770This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
6771evaluation purposes.
6772
6773@smallexample
6774 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
6775@end smallexample
6776
a4f5ad88
JJ
6777@item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6778@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6779This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
eec2f3ed 6780@samp{-z relro} option is used.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6781When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
6782does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
def5c83c
AM
6783@var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
6784argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
6785script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
eec2f3ed
AM
6786@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
6787padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
6788section alignment.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6789
6790@smallexample
6791 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
6792@end smallexample
6793
252b5132
RH
6794@item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6795@kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6796@cindex symbol defaults
6797Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
420e579c
HPN
6798defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
6799return 0. You can use this function to provide
252b5132
RH
6800default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
6801shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
6802the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
6803existed, its value is preserved:
6804
6805@smallexample
6806@group
6807SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6808 .text : @{
6809 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
6810 @dots{}
6811 @}
6812 @dots{}
6813@}
6814@end group
6815@end smallexample
6816
3ec57632
NC
6817@item LENGTH(@var{memory})
6818@kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
6819Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6820
252b5132
RH
6821@item LOADADDR(@var{section})
6822@kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
6823@cindex section load address in expression
7542af2a 6824Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
252b5132
RH
6825Section LMA}).
6826
2e53f7d6
NC
6827@item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6828@kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6829Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
6830@code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
6831
252b5132
RH
6832@kindex MAX
6833@item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6834Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6835
6836@kindex MIN
6837@item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6838Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6839
6840@item NEXT(@var{exp})
6841@kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
6842@cindex unallocated address, next
6843Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
6844This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
6845use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
6846output file, the two functions are equivalent.
6847
3ec57632
NC
6848@item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6849@kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6850Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6851
ba916c8a
MM
6852@item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6853@kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6854Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
c5da8c7d
NC
6855value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
6856@samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
6857will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
6858can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7542af2a 6859``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
ba916c8a
MM
6860name.
6861
252b5132
RH
6862@item SIZEOF(@var{section})
6863@kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
6864@cindex section size
6865Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6866been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6867evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6868@code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
6869@smallexample
6870@group
6871SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6872 .output @{
6873 .start = . ;
6874 @dots{}
6875 .end = . ;
6876 @}
6877 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
6878 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
6879@dots{} @}
6880@end group
6881@end smallexample
6882
6883@item SIZEOF_HEADERS
6884@itemx sizeof_headers
6885@kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
6886@cindex header size
6887Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
6888information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
6889this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
6890choose, to facilitate paging.
6891
6892@cindex not enough room for program headers
6893@cindex program headers, not enough room
6894When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
6895@code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
6896number of program headers before it has determined all the section
6897addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
6898additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
6899room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
6900the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
6901script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
6902you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
6903command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
6904@end table
6905
6906@node Implicit Linker Scripts
6907@section Implicit Linker Scripts
6908@cindex implicit linker scripts
6909If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
6910an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
6911linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
6912linker will report an error.
6913
6914An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
6915
6916Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
6917assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
6918commands.
6919
6920Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
6921at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
6922read. This can affect archive searching.
6923
6924@ifset GENERIC
6925@node Machine Dependent
6926@chapter Machine Dependent Features
6927
6928@cindex machine dependencies
ff5dcc92
SC
6929@command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
6930sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
252b5132
RH
6931functionality are not listed.
6932
6933@menu
36f63dca
NC
6934@ifset H8300
6935* H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
6936@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
6937@ifset M68HC11
6938* M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
6939@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
6940@ifset ARM
6941* ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
6942@end ifset
6943@ifset HPPA
6944* HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
6945@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
6946@ifset M68K
6947* M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
6948@end ifset
833794fc
MR
6949@ifset MIPS
6950* MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
6951@end ifset
3c3bdf30 6952@ifset MMIX
36f63dca 6953* MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
3c3bdf30 6954@end ifset
2469cfa2 6955@ifset MSP430
36f63dca 6956* MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
2469cfa2 6957@end ifset
35c08157
KLC
6958@ifset NDS32
6959* NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
6960@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
6961@ifset NIOSII
6962* Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
6963@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
6964@ifset POWERPC
6965* PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
6966@end ifset
6967@ifset POWERPC64
6968* PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
6969@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
6970@ifset S/390
6971* S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
6972@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
6973@ifset SPU
6974* SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
6975@end ifset
74459f0e 6976@ifset TICOFF
ff5dcc92 6977* TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
74459f0e 6978@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
6979@ifset WIN32
6980* WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
6981@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
6982@ifset XTENSA
6983* Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
6984@end ifset
252b5132
RH
6985@end menu
6986@end ifset
6987
252b5132
RH
6988@ifset H8300
6989@ifclear GENERIC
6990@raisesections
6991@end ifclear
6992
6993@node H8/300
ff5dcc92 6994@section @command{ld} and the H8/300
252b5132
RH
6995
6996@cindex H8/300 support
ff5dcc92 6997For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
252b5132
RH
6998you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
6999
7000@table @emph
7001@cindex relaxing on H8/300
7002@item relaxing address modes
ff5dcc92 7003@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
252b5132
RH
7004targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7005program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7006respectively.
7007
7008@cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7009@item synthesizing instructions
81f5558e 7010@c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
ff5dcc92 7011@command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
252b5132
RH
7012sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7013page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7014(That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7015@samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7016top page of memory).
1502569c 7017
81f5558e
NC
7018@command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7019indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7020displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7021the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7022@code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7023whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7024range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7025
1502569c 7026@item bit manipulation instructions
c0065db7 7027@command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
1502569c 7028biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
c0065db7 7029which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
1502569c
NC
7030page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7031(That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
c0065db7 7032@samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c
NC
7033the top page of memory).
7034
7035@item system control instructions
c0065db7
RM
7036@command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
703732 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
1502569c
NC
7038changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7039(That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
c0065db7 7040@samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c 7041the top page of memory).
252b5132
RH
7042@end table
7043
7044@ifclear GENERIC
7045@lowersections
7046@end ifclear
7047@end ifset
7048
36f63dca 7049@ifclear GENERIC
c2dcd04e 7050@ifset Renesas
36f63dca 7051@c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
c2dcd04e
NC
7052@c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7053@node Renesas
7054@chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
36f63dca 7055
c2dcd04e
NC
7056@command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7057H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7058options are required for these chips.
36f63dca
NC
7059@end ifset
7060@end ifclear
7061
36f63dca
NC
7062@ifset ARM
7063@ifclear GENERIC
7064@raisesections
7065@end ifclear
7066
93fd0973
SC
7067@ifset M68HC11
7068@ifclear GENERIC
7069@raisesections
7070@end ifclear
7071
7072@node M68HC11/68HC12
7073@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7074
7075@cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7076
7077@subsection Linker Relaxation
7078
7079For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7080optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7081
7082@table @emph
7083@cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7084@item relaxing address modes
7085@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7086targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7087program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7088respectively.
7089
7090@command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7091transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7092page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7093
7094@item relaxing gcc instruction group
7095When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7096of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7097addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7098@code{bset} instructions.
7099
7100@end table
7101
7102@subsection Trampoline Generation
7103
7104@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7105@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7106For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7107call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
c0065db7 7108will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
93fd0973
SC
7109trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7110case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7111point to the function trampoline.
7112
7113@ifclear GENERIC
7114@lowersections
7115@end ifclear
7116@end ifset
7117
36f63dca 7118@node ARM
3674e28a 7119@section @command{ld} and the ARM family
36f63dca
NC
7120
7121@cindex ARM interworking support
7122@kindex --support-old-code
7123For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
b45619c0 7124between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
36f63dca
NC
7125been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7126line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7127libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
a05a5b64 7128option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
36f63dca
NC
7129given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7130which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7131the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7132non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7133
7134@cindex thumb entry point
7135@cindex entry point, thumb
7136@kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7137The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7138@samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7139But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7140branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7141executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7142
ce11ba6c
KT
7143@cindex PE import table prefixing
7144@kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7145The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7146the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
11e7fd74 7147element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
ce11ba6c
KT
7148import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7149
e489d0ae
PB
7150@cindex BE8
7151@kindex --be8
7152The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
080bb7bb
NC
7153executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7154objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7155option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7156little-endian code.
e489d0ae 7157
3674e28a
PB
7158@cindex TARGET1
7159@kindex --target1-rel
7160@kindex --target1-abs
7161The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7162@samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7163or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7164and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7165
7166@cindex TARGET2
7167@kindex --target2=@var{type}
7168The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7169@samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7170meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7171@table @samp
7172@item rel
eeac373a
PB
7173@samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7174@item abs
7175@samp{R_ARM_ABS32} (arm*-*-symbianelf)
3674e28a
PB
7176@item got-rel
7177@samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7178@end table
7179
319850b4
JB
7180@cindex FIX_V4BX
7181@kindex --fix-v4bx
7182The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7183specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7184interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7185also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7186
7187In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7188linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7189@code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7190
7191In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7192relocations are ignored.
7193
845b51d6
PB
7194@cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7195@kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7196Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7197relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7198
7199@smallexample
7200TST rM, #1
7201MOVEQ PC, rM
7202BX Rn
7203@end smallexample
7204
7205This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7206and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
11e7fd74 7207condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
845b51d6 7208
33bfe774
JB
7209@cindex USE_BLX
7210@kindex --use-blx
7211The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7212BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7213situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7214code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7215each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7216
7217This option is enabled implicitly for SymbianOS, so there is no need to
7218specify it if you are using that target.
7219
c6dd86c6
JB
7220@cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7221@kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7222The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7223bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7224instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7225to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7226the support code can read the intended values.
7227
7228The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7229intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7230and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7231intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7232full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7233you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7234
7235If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7236enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7237@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7238mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7239vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7240@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7241
7242If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7243potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7244such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7245first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7246instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7247the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7248are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7249
2de70689
MGD
7250@cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7251@kindex --fix-arm1176
7252@kindex --no-fix-arm1176
9d5777a3
RM
7253The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7254in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7255are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
2de70689
MGD
7256unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7257
9d5777a3 7258Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
11e7fd74 7259Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
2de70689
MGD
7260http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7261
a504d23a
LA
7262@cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7263@kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7264
7265The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7266workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7267the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7268off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7269the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7270core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7271integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7272VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7273
7274The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7275necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7276
7277The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7278@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7279STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7280linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7281@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7282
7283If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7284potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7285such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7286replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7287branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7288then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7289
7290The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7291the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7292
7293The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7294they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7295there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7296occurs.
7297
7298The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7299PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7300large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7301cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7302occurs.
7303
bf21ed78
MS
7304@cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7305@kindex --no-enum-size-warning
726150b7 7306The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
bf21ed78
MS
7307warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7308enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7309linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7310using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7311not be diagnosed.
a9dc9481
JM
7312
7313@cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7314@kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7315The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7316warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7317@code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7318linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7319using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
bf21ed78 7320
726150b7
NC
7321@cindex PIC_VENEER
7322@kindex --pic-veneer
7323The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7324ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7325is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7326@samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7327
7328@cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7329@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7330The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7331code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7332perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7333placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
a05a5b64 7334controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
726150b7 7335The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
11e7fd74 7336duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
726150b7
NC
7337group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7338code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7339where they should be placed.
7340
7341The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7342@option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
07d72278 7343placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
726150b7
NC
7344branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7345placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7346value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7347exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7348A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7349linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7350from the input sections.
7351
7352The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7353@samp{N = +1}.
7354
1a51c1a4
NC
7355Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7356only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7357otherwise.
7358
1db37fe6
YG
7359@cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7360@kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7361@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7362The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7363
7364The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7365
68fcca92
JW
7366@cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7367@kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7368@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7369The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7370
7371Please contact ARM for further details.
7372
1db37fe6
YG
7373@kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7374@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7375@cindex Merging exidx entries
7376The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7377
7378@kindex --long-plt
7379@cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7380The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7381which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7382entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7383
1f56df9d
JW
7384@kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7385@cindex AArch64 rela addend
7386The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7387link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7388
4ba2ef8f
TP
7389@cindex Placement of SG veneers
7390All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
a05a5b64 7391Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
4ba2ef8f
TP
7392@samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7393veneers in memory.
7394
54ddd295
TP
7395@kindex --cmse-implib
7396@cindex Secure gateway import library
7397The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7398specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7399secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7400executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7401
0955507f
TP
7402@kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7403@cindex Input import library
7404The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7405must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7406given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7407in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7408@samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7409library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7410library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7411for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7412specified.
7413
36f63dca
NC
7414@ifclear GENERIC
7415@lowersections
7416@end ifclear
7417@end ifset
7418
7419@ifset HPPA
7420@ifclear GENERIC
7421@raisesections
7422@end ifclear
7423
7424@node HPPA ELF32
7425@section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7426@cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7427@kindex --multi-subspace
7428When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7429import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7430The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7431stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7432multiple sub-spaces.
7433
7434@cindex HPPA stub grouping
7435@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7436Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7437stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7438@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7439sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7440a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7441the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7442conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7443prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7444A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7445branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7446@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7447@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7448detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7449positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7450
7451Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7452single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7453create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7454large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7455
7456@ifclear GENERIC
7457@lowersections
7458@end ifclear
7459@end ifset
7460
7fb9f789
NC
7461@ifset M68K
7462@ifclear GENERIC
7463@raisesections
7464@end ifclear
7465
7466@node M68K
7467@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7468
7469@cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7470@kindex --got=@var{type}
7471The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7472The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7473@samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7474the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7475@samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7476entries only at non-negative offsets.
7477@samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7478entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7479support such GOTs.
7480@samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7481output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7482file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7483files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7484
7485@ifclear GENERIC
7486@lowersections
7487@end ifclear
7488@end ifset
7489
833794fc
MR
7490@ifset MIPS
7491@ifclear GENERIC
7492@raisesections
7493@end ifclear
7494
7495@node MIPS
7496@section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7497
7498@cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7499@kindex --insn32
7500@kindex --no-insn32
7501The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7502microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7503in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7504used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7505or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7506including 16-bit ones where possible.
7507
8b10b0b3
MR
7508@cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7509@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7510@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7511The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7512control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7513@samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7514relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7515calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7516relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7517instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7518or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7519the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7520
833794fc
MR
7521@ifclear GENERIC
7522@lowersections
7523@end ifclear
7524@end ifset
7525
36f63dca
NC
7526@ifset MMIX
7527@ifclear GENERIC
7528@raisesections
7529@end ifclear
7530
7531@node MMIX
7532@section @code{ld} and MMIX
7533For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7534@code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7535understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7536can translate between the two formats.
7537
7538There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7539Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7540registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7541equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7542@samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7543global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7544this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7545symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7546
7a2de473
HPN
7547Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7548@code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7549The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7550of a section.
36f63dca
NC
7551
7552Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7553are left out from an mmo file.
7554
7555@ifclear GENERIC
7556@lowersections
7557@end ifclear
7558@end ifset
7559
7560@ifset MSP430
7561@ifclear GENERIC
7562@raisesections
7563@end ifclear
7564
7565@node MSP430
7566@section @code{ld} and MSP430
7567For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7568will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7569just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7570
7571@cindex MSP430 extra sections
7572The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7573
7574@table @code
7575@item @samp{.vectors}
7576Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7577
7578@item @samp{.bootloader}
7579Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7580in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7581
7582@item @samp{.infomem}
7583Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7584this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7585
c0065db7 7586@item @samp{.infomemnobits}
36f63dca
NC
7587This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7588in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7589
7590@item @samp{.noinit}
7591Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7592
c0065db7 7593The last two sections are used by gcc.
36f63dca
NC
7594@end table
7595
7ef3addb
JL
7596@table @option
7597@cindex MSP430 Options
7598@kindex --code-region
7599@item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7600This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7601argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7602using this option.
7603
7604@kindex --data-region
7605@item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7606This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7607[either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7608for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7609
7610@kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7611@item --disable-sec-transformation
7612Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7613and @code{--data-region} options.
7614This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7615wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7616not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7617@end table
7618
36f63dca
NC
7619@ifclear GENERIC
7620@lowersections
7621@end ifclear
7622@end ifset
7623
35c08157
KLC
7624@ifset NDS32
7625@ifclear GENERIC
7626@raisesections
7627@end ifclear
7628
7629@node NDS32
7630@section @code{ld} and NDS32
7631@kindex relaxing on NDS32
7632For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7633relaxes objects according to these options.
7634
7635@table @code
7636@item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7637Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7638
7639@item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7640Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7641
7642@item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7643Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7644
7645@item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7646Export the EX9 table after linking.
7647
7648@item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7649Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7650
7651@item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7652Update the existing EX9 table.
7653
7654@item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7655Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7656
7657@item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7658Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7659
7660@item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7661Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7662
7663@item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7664Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7665@end table
7666
7667@ifclear GENERIC
7668@lowersections
7669@end ifclear
7670@end ifset
7671
78058a5e
SL
7672@ifset NIOSII
7673@ifclear GENERIC
7674@raisesections
7675@end ifclear
7676
7677@node Nios II
7678@section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7679@cindex Nios II call relaxation
7680@kindex --relax on Nios II
7681
7682Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7683transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7684which may result in @command{ld} giving
7685@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7686The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7687trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7688outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7689trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7690be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7691larger than 256MB.
7692
7693The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7694is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7695@option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7696locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7697source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7698register as a temporary.
7699
7700Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7701relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7702option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7703
7704@ifclear GENERIC
7705@lowersections
7706@end ifclear
7707@end ifset
7708
2a60a7a8
AM
7709@ifset POWERPC
7710@ifclear GENERIC
7711@raisesections
7712@end ifclear
7713
7714@node PowerPC ELF32
7715@section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7716@cindex PowerPC long branches
7717@kindex --relax on PowerPC
7718Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
7719displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
7720@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7721@samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
7722the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
7723section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
c8a1f254
NS
7724section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
7725@samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
7726both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
7727considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
2a60a7a8
AM
7728
7729@cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
7730@table @option
7731@cindex PowerPC PLT
7732@kindex --bss-plt
7733@item --bss-plt
7734Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
7735generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
7736the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
7737writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
7738@command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
7739PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
7740compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
7741BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
7742
016687f8
AM
7743@kindex --secure-plt
7744@item --secure-plt
7745@command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
7746@samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
7747when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
7748layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
7749style BSS PLT.
7750
2a60a7a8
AM
7751@cindex PowerPC GOT
7752@kindex --sdata-got
7753@item --sdata-got
7754The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
7755sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
7756@code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
7757section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
7758@code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
7759@code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
7760@samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
7761@code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
7762PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
7763pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
7764GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
7765really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
7766
7767@cindex PowerPC stub symbols
7768@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7769@item --emit-stub-syms
7770This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7771symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7772
7773@cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
7774@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7775@item --no-tls-optimize
7776PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7777sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7778disable the optimization.
7779@end table
7780
7781@ifclear GENERIC
7782@lowersections
7783@end ifclear
7784@end ifset
7785
7786@ifset POWERPC64
7787@ifclear GENERIC
7788@raisesections
7789@end ifclear
7790
7791@node PowerPC64 ELF64
7792@section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7793
7794@cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
7795@table @option
7796@cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
7797@kindex --stub-group-size
7798@item --stub-group-size
7799Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
7800by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7801@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7802sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7803a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7804the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7805conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7806prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7807A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7808branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7809@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7810@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7811detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7812positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7813
7814Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7815single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7816create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7817large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7818
7819@cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
7820@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7821@item --emit-stub-syms
7822This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7823symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7824
7825@cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
7826@kindex --dotsyms
7827@kindex --no-dotsyms
95421fb9
AM
7828@item --dotsyms
7829@itemx --no-dotsyms
2a60a7a8
AM
7830These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
7831in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
7832function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
7833code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
7834properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
7835to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
7836@samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
7837dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
7838feature.
7839
7ae4ea7d
AM
7840@cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
7841@kindex --save-restore-funcs
7842@kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
95421fb9
AM
7843@item --save-restore-funcs
7844@itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7ae4ea7d
AM
7845These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
7846provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
7847@samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
7848function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
7849link.
7850
2a60a7a8
AM
7851@cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
7852@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7853@item --no-tls-optimize
7854PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7855sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7856disable the optimization.
7857
7c9cf415
AM
7858@cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
7859@kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
7860@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa
AM
7861@kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
7862@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
95421fb9
AM
7863@item --tls-get-addr-optimize
7864@itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa 7865These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7c9cf415
AM
7866stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
7867an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
7868@code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
9e7028aa
AM
7869stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
7870generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
7871__tls_get_addr_opt.
7872Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
7873much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
7874an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
7875will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
7876@option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
7877and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
7878this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
7879Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
5cebc931 7880@option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
9e7028aa 7881register saves.
7c9cf415 7882
2a60a7a8
AM
7883@cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
7884@kindex --no-opd-optimize
7885@item --no-opd-optimize
7886PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
7887corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
e7fc76dd 7888the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
2a60a7a8
AM
7889Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
7890
7891@cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
7892@kindex --non-overlapping-opd
7893@item --non-overlapping-opd
7894Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
7895@code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
7896the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
7897entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
7898
7899@cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
7900@kindex --no-toc-optimize
7901@item --no-toc-optimize
7902PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
7903entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
7904reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
7905marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
7906marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
7907relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
7908unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
7909reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
7910discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
7911reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
7912code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
7913optimization.
7914
d882c988
AM
7915@cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
7916@kindex --no-inline-optimize
7917@item --no-inline-optimize
7918PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
7919marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
7920@code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
7921a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
7922locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
7923disables that optimization.
7924
2a60a7a8
AM
7925@cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
7926@kindex --no-multi-toc
7927@item --no-multi-toc
794e51c0
AM
7928If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
7929@code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
7930where TOC
2a60a7a8
AM
7931entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
7932total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
7933grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
7934TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
7935calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
7936help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
793764K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
7938Use this option to turn off this feature.
794e51c0
AM
7939
7940@cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
7941@kindex --no-toc-sort
7942@item --no-toc-sort
7943By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
7944happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
7945placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
7946with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
7947referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
7948@code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
7949results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
7950off this feature.
7951
7952@cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
7953@kindex --plt-align
7954@kindex --no-plt-align
7955@item --plt-align
7956@itemx --no-plt-align
7957Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
2420fff6
AM
7958aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
7959boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
7960specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
7961specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
7962if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
7963PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
794e51c0
AM
7964
7965@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
7966@kindex --plt-static-chain
7967@kindex --no-plt-static-chain
7968@item --plt-static-chain
7969@itemx --no-plt-static-chain
7970Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
7971chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
7972chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
7973
7974@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
7975@kindex --plt-thread-safe
7976@kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
7977@item --plt-thread-safe
1be5d8d3 7978@itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
794e51c0
AM
7979With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
7980lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
7981another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
7982order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
7983memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
7984barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
7985looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
7986seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
7987default behaviour.
8b5f1ed8
AM
7988
7989@cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
7990@kindex --plt-localentry
7991@kindex --no-plt-localentry
7992@item --plt-localentry
7993@itemx --no-localentry
7994ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
7995ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
7996(the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
7997Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
7998or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
7999functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8000in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
d44c746a
AM
8001interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8002including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8003to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8004complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8005care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
d882c988
AM
8006
8007@cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8008@kindex --power10-stubs
8009@kindex --no-power10-stubs
8010@item --power10-stubs
8011@itemx --no-power10-stubs
8012When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8013relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
e10a07b3
AM
8014linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8015for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8016power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
d882c988
AM
8017power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8018allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
e10a07b3
AM
8019@option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8020auto mode.
2a60a7a8
AM
8021@end table
8022
8023@ifclear GENERIC
8024@lowersections
8025@end ifclear
8026@end ifset
8027
b4cbbe8f
AK
8028@ifset S/390
8029@ifclear GENERIC
8030@raisesections
8031@end ifclear
8032
8033@node S/390 ELF
8034@section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8035
8036@cindex S/390 ELF options
8037@table @option
8038
8039@cindex S/390
8040@kindex --s390-pgste
8041@item --s390-pgste
8042This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8043segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8044binaries marked that way.
8045@end table
8046
8047@ifclear GENERIC
8048@lowersections
8049@end ifclear
8050@end ifset
8051
49fa1e15
AM
8052@ifset SPU
8053@ifclear GENERIC
8054@raisesections
8055@end ifclear
8056
8057@node SPU ELF
8058@section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8059
8060@cindex SPU ELF options
8061@table @option
8062
8063@cindex SPU plugins
8064@kindex --plugin
8065@item --plugin
8066This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8067
8068@cindex SPU overlays
8069@kindex --no-overlays
8070@item --no-overlays
8071Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8072regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8073@command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8074turns off all this special overlay handling.
8075
8076@cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8077@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8078@item --emit-stub-syms
8079This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8080symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8081
8082@cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8083@kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8084@item --extra-overlay-stubs
8085This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8086function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8087on calls to non-overlay regions.
8088
8089@cindex SPU local store size
8090@kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8091@item --local-store=lo:hi
8092@command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8093the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8094range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8095
c0065db7 8096@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8097@kindex --stack-analysis
8098@item --stack-analysis
8099SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8100unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8101under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8102@command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8103@command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8104determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8105for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8106for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8107for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8108find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8109and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8110under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8111dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8112is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8113and calls will be given.
8114
c0065db7 8115@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8116@kindex --emit-stack-syms
8117@item --emit-stack-syms
8118This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8119in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8120These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8121functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8122functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8123such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8124The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
c0065db7 8125@code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
49fa1e15
AM
8126@end table
8127
8128@ifclear GENERIC
8129@lowersections
8130@end ifclear
8131@end ifset
8132
36f63dca
NC
8133@ifset TICOFF
8134@ifclear GENERIC
8135@raisesections
8136@end ifclear
8137
8138@node TI COFF
8139@section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8140@cindex TI COFF versions
8141@kindex --format=@var{version}
8142The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8143TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8144also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8145format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8146header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8147
8148@ifclear GENERIC
8149@lowersections
8150@end ifclear
8151@end ifset
8152
2ca22b03
NC
8153@ifset WIN32
8154@ifclear GENERIC
8155@raisesections
8156@end ifclear
8157
8158@node WIN32
8159@section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8160
c0065db7 8161This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
a05a5b64
TP
8162See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8163command-line options mentioned here.
2ca22b03
NC
8164
8165@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8166@cindex import libraries
8167@item import libraries
69da35b5 8168The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
2ca22b03 8169libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
69da35b5
NC
8170regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8171archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
2ca22b03 8172support for creating such libraries provided with the
a05a5b64 8173@samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
2ca22b03 8174
c0065db7
RM
8175@item exporting DLL symbols
8176@cindex exporting DLL symbols
dc8465bf
NC
8177The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8178
8179@table @emph
8180@item using auto-export functionality
8181@cindex using auto-export functionality
8182By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
a05a5b64 8183which is controlled by the following command-line options:
dc8465bf 8184
0a5d968e
NC
8185@itemize
8186@item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8187@item --exclude-symbols
8188@item --exclude-libs
e1c37eb5 8189@item --exclude-modules-for-implib
09e2aba4 8190@item --version-script
0a5d968e
NC
8191@end itemize
8192
09e2aba4
DK
8193When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8194(global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8195symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8196often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8197private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
9d5777a3 8198options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
09e2aba4
DK
8199exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8200final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8201
8202If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
0a5d968e
NC
8203command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8204if either of the following are true:
8205
8206@itemize
8207@item A DEF file is used.
8208@item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8209@end itemize
dc8465bf 8210
c0065db7
RM
8211@item using a DEF file
8212@cindex using a DEF file
dc8465bf
NC
8213Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8214an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8215exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8216name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
0a5d968e 8217command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
dc8465bf
NC
8218
8219@example
8220gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8221@end example
8222
0a5d968e
NC
8223Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8224@samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8225
dc8465bf
NC
8226Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8227
8228@example
4b5bd4e7 8229LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
dc8465bf
NC
8230
8231EXPORTS
8232foo
8233bar
8234_bar = bar
4b5bd4e7
DS
8235another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8236var1 DATA
7fcab871
KT
8237doo = foo == foo2
8238eoo DATA == var1
c0065db7 8239@end example
dc8465bf 8240
7fcab871 8241This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
4b5bd4e7
DS
8242symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8243alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8244by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8245@code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
7fcab871
KT
8246@code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8247export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8248in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8249symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
4b5bd4e7 8250
6b31ad16
DS
8251The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8252name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8253the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8254
b45619c0
NC
8255When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8256library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
6b31ad16 8257@code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
c0065db7 8258executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
6b31ad16
DS
8259
8260With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8261specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
c0065db7 8262non-default base address for the image.
6b31ad16
DS
8263
8264If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
a2877985
DS
8265or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8266filename specified on the command line.
6b31ad16 8267
4b5bd4e7
DS
8268The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8269
8270@example
8271EXPORTS
8272 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8273 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
7fcab871 8274 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
c0065db7 8275@end example
4b5bd4e7
DS
8276
8277Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8278@samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8279@samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8280@samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8281Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
7fcab871
KT
8282@samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8283string in import/export table for the symbol.
4b5bd4e7
DS
8284
8285The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8286
8287@code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8288will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8289by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8290linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8291library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8292
8293@code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8294The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8295the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8296@code{*_imp__foo}).
8297
8298@code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8299well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8300read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8301variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8302the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8303extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8304application will behave unexpectedly.
8305
8306@code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8307it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8308symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
de194d85 8309API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
4b5bd4e7 8310the DLL without an import library.
c0065db7 8311
4b5bd4e7
DS
8312See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8313other DEF file statements
dc8465bf
NC
8314
8315@cindex creating a DEF file
8316While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
a05a5b64 8317with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
0a5d968e
NC
8318
8319@item Using decorations
8320@cindex Using decorations
8321Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8322itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8323declared as:
8324
8325@example
8326__declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8327__declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8328@end example
8329
8330All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8331any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8332this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8333the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8334
8335Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
c0065db7 8336decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
0a5d968e
NC
8337instead:
8338
8339@example
8340__declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8341__declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8342@end example
8343
c0065db7
RM
8344This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8345when included by the library itself the header must declare the
0a5d968e
NC
8346variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8347code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
c0065db7 8348of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
0a5d968e
NC
8349omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8350@samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
b45619c0 8351information.
c0065db7 8352@end table
dc8465bf 8353
2ca22b03
NC
8354@cindex automatic data imports
8355@item automatic data imports
8356The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
69da35b5 8357by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
2ca22b03 8358compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
c0065db7 8359issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
69da35b5 8360code to these platforms, especially for large
2ca22b03 8361c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
c0065db7 8362initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
b45619c0 8363decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
c0065db7 8364platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
69da35b5
NC
8365command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8366The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8367suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8368trigger the feature's use.
8369
c0065db7 8370auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
69da35b5
NC
8371additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8372
c0065db7 8373"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
69da35b5
NC
8374documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8375
c0065db7
RM
8376The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8377occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8378One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
69da35b5
NC
8379below.
8380
8381@cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
c0065db7
RM
8382For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8383object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8384offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8385field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8386in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
69da35b5 8387without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
c0065db7 8388The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
69da35b5
NC
8389references.
8390
c0065db7
RM
8391The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8392be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8393themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8394runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8395compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8396support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
69da35b5
NC
8397run without error on an older system.
8398
c0065db7
RM
8399@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8400enabled as needed.
2ca22b03
NC
8401
8402@cindex direct linking to a dll
8403@item direct linking to a dll
8404The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8405including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
69da35b5 8406libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
b45619c0 8407traditional import library method, especially when linking large
c0065db7
RM
8408libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8409function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8410though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
69da35b5 8411storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
c0065db7 8412tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
69da35b5
NC
8413large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8414
c0065db7 8415Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
69da35b5 8416@samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
c0065db7 8417of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
69da35b5
NC
8418perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8419select the dll instead of an import library.
8420
2ca22b03 8421
69da35b5
NC
8422For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8423to find, in the first directory of its search path,
2ca22b03
NC
8424
8425@example
45e948fe
NC
8426libxxx.dll.a
8427xxx.dll.a
8428libxxx.a
8429xxx.lib
f6c4d4b1 8430libxxx.lib
69da35b5 8431cygxxx.dll (*)
45e948fe
NC
8432libxxx.dll
8433xxx.dll
2ca22b03
NC
8434@end example
8435
69da35b5
NC
8436before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8437
c0065db7
RM
8438(*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8439where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8440@samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8441file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
69da35b5
NC
8442@samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8443
c0065db7
RM
8444Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8445@samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
69da35b5
NC
8446was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8447various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8448could coexist on the same machine.
8449
2ca22b03
NC
8450The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8451applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
69da35b5 8452libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
2ca22b03
NC
8453
8454@example
8455bin/
8456 cygxxx.dll
8457lib/
8458 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
c0065db7 8459 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
2ca22b03
NC
8460@end example
8461
c0065db7
RM
8462Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8463done two ways:
2ca22b03
NC
8464
84651. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8466@example
8467gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8468@end example
2ca22b03 8469
69da35b5
NC
8470However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8471(@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8472@samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8473not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8474
2ca22b03
NC
84752. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8476directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8477should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8478making the app/dll.
8479
8480@example
8481ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
c0065db7 8482@end example
2ca22b03
NC
8483
8484Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8485
8486@example
8487gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8488@end example
69da35b5
NC
8489
8490This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8491perfectly legal
8492
8493@example
8494bin/
8495 cygxxx-5.dll
8496lib/
c0065db7 8497 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
69da35b5
NC
8498@end example
8499
dc8465bf 8500Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
69da35b5
NC
8501even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8502@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8503
8504Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
45e948fe 8505wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
69da35b5
NC
8506
85071. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8508work with auto-imported data.
8509
dc8465bf
NC
85102. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8511import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8512symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8513for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8514possible to do this without an import lib.
69da35b5 8515
45e948fe
NC
85163. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8517critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8518in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8519stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8520
69da35b5 8521So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
c0065db7
RM
8522true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8523a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8524binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
69da35b5
NC
8525massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8526requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8527will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
dc8465bf 8528
c0065db7 8529@item symbol aliasing
dc8465bf 8530@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8531@item adding additional names
8532Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
dc8465bf
NC
8533A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8534exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8535when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
c0065db7 8536import library. Consider the following DEF file:
dc8465bf 8537
c0065db7 8538@example
dc8465bf
NC
8539LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8540
8541EXPORTS
c0065db7 8542foo
dc8465bf 8543_foo = foo
c0065db7 8544@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8545
8546The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8547
8548Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8549source code using the "weak" attribute:
8550
c0065db7
RM
8551@example
8552void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
dc8465bf 8553void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
c0065db7 8554@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8555
8556See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8557symbols.
8558
8559@item renaming symbols
8560Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
c0065db7 8561kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
dc8465bf
NC
8562@samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8563DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
c0065db7 8564created). In the following example:
dc8465bf 8565
c0065db7 8566@example
dc8465bf
NC
8567LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8568
8569EXPORTS
8570_foo = foo
c0065db7 8571@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8572
8573The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8574@samp{_foo}.
c0065db7 8575@end table
dc8465bf 8576
0a5d968e 8577Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
a05a5b64 8578unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
0a5d968e 8579If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
c0065db7
RM
8580@emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8581that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8582@samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8583renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8584to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8585the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8586In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
0a5d968e 8587which is probably not what you wanted.
c87db184
CF
8588
8589@cindex weak externals
8590@item weak externals
8591The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8592weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8593defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8594are three variants of weak externals:
8595@itemize
8596@item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8597called lazy externals.
8598@item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8599This form is not presently implemented.
8600@item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8601implemented.
8602@end itemize
8603As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8604are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8605uses a default value.
c1711530
DK
8606
8607@cindex aligned common symbols
8608@item aligned common symbols
8609As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8610desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8611the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8612carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8613by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8614tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8615but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8616warnings about unknown linker directives.
5063daf7 8617
2ca22b03
NC
8618@end table
8619
8620@ifclear GENERIC
8621@lowersections
8622@end ifclear
8623@end ifset
8624
e0001a05
NC
8625@ifset XTENSA
8626@ifclear GENERIC
8627@raisesections
8628@end ifclear
8629
8630@node Xtensa
8631@section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8632
8633@cindex Xtensa processors
8634The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8635@code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8636specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8637keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8638example, with the command:
8639
8640@smallexample
8641SECTIONS
8642@{
8643 .text : @{
8644 *(.literal .text)
8645 @}
8646@}
8647@end smallexample
8648
8649@noindent
8650@command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8651and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8652literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8653interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8654group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8655files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8656and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
e0001a05 8657
43cd72b9 8658@cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
e0001a05 8659@cindex relaxing on Xtensa
43cd72b9
BW
8660Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8661provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8662is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8663literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8664will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8665location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8666the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8667unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8668@code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8669range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8670
8671For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8672to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8673instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8674instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8675instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8676@code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8677hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8678By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8679switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8680density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8681instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8682performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8683linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8684a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8685
8686The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8687control the linker:
8688
8689@cindex Xtensa options
8690@table @option
43cd72b9
BW
8691@item --size-opt
8692When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8693more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8694no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8695alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8696preserve the correctness of the code.
7a77f1ac
MF
8697
8698@item --abi-windowed
8699@itemx --abi-call0
8700Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8701PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8702because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8703conventions.
8704Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8705of the first input object.
8706A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8707or the chosen output object ABI.
43cd72b9 8708@end table
e0001a05
NC
8709
8710@ifclear GENERIC
8711@lowersections
8712@end ifclear
8713@end ifset
8714
252b5132
RH
8715@ifclear SingleFormat
8716@node BFD
8717@chapter BFD
8718
8719@cindex back end
8720@cindex object file management
8721@cindex object formats available
8722@kindex objdump -i
8723The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
8724These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
8725object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
8726format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
8727it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
8728associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
8729object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
8730(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
8731list all the formats available for your configuration.
8732
8733@cindex BFD requirements
8734@cindex requirements for BFD
8735As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
8736several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
8737BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
8738formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
8739been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
8740BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
8741may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
8742
8743One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
8744mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
8745useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
8746conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
8747
8748@menu
8749* BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
8750@end menu
8751
8752@node BFD outline
36f63dca 8753@section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
252b5132
RH
8754@cindex opening object files
8755@include bfdsumm.texi
8756@end ifclear
8757
8758@node Reporting Bugs
8759@chapter Reporting Bugs
ff5dcc92
SC
8760@cindex bugs in @command{ld}
8761@cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
252b5132 8762
ff5dcc92 8763Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
252b5132
RH
8764
8765Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
8766it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
ff5dcc92 8767to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
252b5132 8768work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
ff5dcc92 8769@command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8770
8771In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
8772information that enables us to fix the bug.
8773
8774@menu
8775* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
8776* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
8777@end menu
8778
8779@node Bug Criteria
36f63dca 8780@section Have You Found a Bug?
252b5132
RH
8781@cindex bug criteria
8782
8783If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
8784
8785@itemize @bullet
8786@cindex fatal signal
8787@cindex linker crash
8788@cindex crash of linker
8789@item
8790If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
ff5dcc92 8791@command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
252b5132
RH
8792
8793@cindex error on valid input
8794@item
ff5dcc92 8795If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
252b5132
RH
8796
8797@cindex invalid input
8798@item
ff5dcc92 8799If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
252b5132
RH
8800may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
8801object files are correct.
8802
8803@item
8804If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
ff5dcc92 8805improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
252b5132
RH
8806@end itemize
8807
8808@node Bug Reporting
36f63dca 8809@section How to Report Bugs
252b5132 8810@cindex bug reports
ff5dcc92 8811@cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
252b5132
RH
8812
8813A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
ff5dcc92 8814products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
252b5132
RH
8815recommend you contact that organization first.
8816
8817You can find contact information for many support companies and
8818individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
8819distribution.
8820
ad22bfe8 8821@ifset BUGURL
ff5dcc92 8822Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
ad22bfe8
JM
8823@value{BUGURL}.
8824@end ifset
252b5132
RH
8825
8826The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
8827@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
8828fact or leave it out, state it!
8829
8830Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
8831problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
b553b183
NC
8832assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
8833matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
8834the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
8835location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
8836were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
8837into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
8838specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
c0065db7 8839and the most helpful.
b553b183
NC
8840
8841Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
8842the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
8843on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
252b5132
RH
8844
8845Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36f63dca
NC
8846bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
8847respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
8848You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
252b5132
RH
8849
8850To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
8851
8852@itemize @bullet
8853@item
ff5dcc92 8854The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
252b5132
RH
8855the @samp{--version} argument.
8856
8857Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
ff5dcc92 8858the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8859
8860@item
ff5dcc92 8861Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
252b5132
RH
8862patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
8863
8864@item
8865The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
8866version number.
8867
8868@item
ff5dcc92 8869What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
252b5132
RH
8870``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
8871
8872@item
8873The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
8874observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
8875list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
8876sufficient.
8877
8878If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
8879and then we might not encounter the bug.
8880
8881@item
8882A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
b553b183
NC
8883bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
8884provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
8885bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
8886state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
8887requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
8888we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
8889attachments are best.
252b5132
RH
8890
8891If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
8892@code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
8893object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
8894@code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
8895how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
8896
8897@item
8898A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
8899incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
8900
ff5dcc92 8901Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
252b5132
RH
8902will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
8903not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
8904a chance to make a mistake.
8905
8906Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
8907say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
b45619c0 8908copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
252b5132
RH
8909C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
8910and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
8911fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
8912you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
8913any conclusion from our observations.
8914
8915@item
ff5dcc92 8916If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
252b5132
RH
8917diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
8918@samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
ff5dcc92 8919If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
252b5132
RH
8920context, not by line number.
8921
8922The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
8923sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
8924@end itemize
8925
8926Here are some things that are not necessary:
8927
8928@itemize @bullet
8929@item
8930A description of the envelope of the bug.
8931
8932Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
8933which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
8934changes will not affect it.
8935
8936This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
8937will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
8938with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
8939We recommend that you save your time for something else.
8940
8941Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
8942of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
8943output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
8944less time, and so on.
8945
8946However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
8947report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
8948
8949@item
8950A patch for the bug.
8951
8952A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
8953the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
8954a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
8955to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
8956
ff5dcc92 8957Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
252b5132
RH
8958construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
8959through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
8960able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
8961fixed.
8962
8963And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
8964patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
8965help us to understand.
8966
8967@item
8968A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
8969
8970Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
8971things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
8972@end itemize
8973
8974@node MRI
8975@appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
8976@cindex MRI compatibility
ff5dcc92
SC
8977To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
8978linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
252b5132
RH
8979alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
8980described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
8981simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
ff5dcc92 8982@command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
252b5132
RH
8983linker commands; these commands are described here.
8984
8985In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
8986file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
8987features to make use of them.
8988
8989You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
8990@samp{-c} command-line option.
8991
8992Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
8993command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
8994blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
ff5dcc92 8995MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
8996issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
8997
8998Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
8999
9000You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9001lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9002The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9003
9004@table @code
9005@cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9006@item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9007@itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9008Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
252b5132
RH
9009the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9010@code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9011your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9012script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9013commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9014input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9015@code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9016
9017@cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9018@item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9019Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9020in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9021
9022@var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9023
9024@cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9025@item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9026Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9027@var{expression} should be a power of two.
9028
9029@cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9030@item BASE @var{expression}
9031Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9032absolute addresses) in the output file.
9033
9034@cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9035@item CHIP @var{expression}
9036@itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9037This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9038
9039@cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9040@item END
9041This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9042
9043@cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9044@item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9045Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
dc12032b 9046language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
252b5132
RH
9047
9048@cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9049@item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9050Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
ff5dcc92 9051@command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
252b5132
RH
9052
9053The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9054same line, with no change in its effect.
9055
9056@cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9057@item LOAD @var{filename}
9058@itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9059Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
ff5dcc92 9060same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9061command line.
9062
9063@cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9064@item NAME @var{output-name}
ff5dcc92 9065@var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
252b5132
RH
9066MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9067option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9068
9069@cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9070@item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9071@itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9072Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
252b5132
RH
9073order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9074script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9075sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9076file, in the order specified.
9077
9078@cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9079@item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9080@itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9081@itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9082Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9083@var{name} used in the linker input files.
9084
9085@cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9086@item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9087@itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9088@itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9089You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9090specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9091If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9092@var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9093@end table
9094
793c5807
NC
9095@node GNU Free Documentation License
9096@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36f63dca 9097@include fdl.texi
704c465c 9098
370b66a1
CD
9099@node LD Index
9100@unnumbered LD Index
252b5132
RH
9101
9102@printindex cp
9103
9104@tex
7ca01ed9 9105% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
252b5132
RH
9106% meantime:
9107\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9108\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9109\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9110\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9111\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9112\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9113\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9114\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9115\page\colophon
7ca01ed9 9116% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
252b5132
RH
9117@end tex
9118
252b5132 9119@bye
This page took 1.594192 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.